The present invention relates to a new and improved method of performing surgery, and instruments, implants, and other surgical implements that can be used in surgery. The surgery may be of any desired type. The surgery may be performed on joints in a patient's body. The surgery may be performed on any desired joint in a patient's body. Regardless of the type of surgery to be performed, a limited incision may advantageously be utilized.
In some embodiments, this specification relates to limited incision partial or total knee joint replacements and revisions and is the result of a continuation of work which was previously performed in conjunction with the subject matter of U.S. Pat. No. 5,514,143. This specification also contains subject matter which relates to U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,163,949; 5,269,785; 5,549,683; 5,662,710; 5,667,520; 5,961,499; 6,059,817; and 6,099,531. Although this specification refers to knee joints, it should be understood that the subject matter of this application is also applicable to joints in many different portions of a patient's body, for example a shoulder, spine, arm, hand, hip or foot of a patient.
During a total or partial knee replacement or revision, an incision is made in a knee portion of a leg of the patient to obtain access to the knee joint. The incision is relatively long to enable instrumentation, such as a femoral alignment guide, anterior resection guide, distal resection guide, femoral cutting guide, and femoral anterior, posterior and chamfer resection guide to be positioned relative to a distal end portion of the femur. In addition, the incision must be relatively large to enable a tibial resection guide to be positioned relative to the proximal end portion of the tibia.
With known procedures of total or partial knee replacement, the incision in the knee portion of the patient is made with the leg of the patient extended (straight) while the patient is lying on his or her back. At this time, the extended leg of the patient is disposed along and rests on a patient support surface. After the incision has been made in the knee portion of the leg of the patient, the leg is flexed and a foot connected with the leg moves along the patient support surface. The knee portion of the flexed leg of the patient is disposed above the patient support surface. This results in the soft tissue in the knee being compressed against the back of the knee joint. This makes it very difficult to access posterior soft tissue to remove bone spurs (ostified), meniscus, posterior capsule, ligaments in the back of the joint, and/or any residual soft tissue or connective tissue that is blocking further flexion.
After the incision has been made and while the leg is flexed with the foot above the patient support surface, the surgeon cannot view arteries, nerves and veins which are sitting just posterior to the knee capsule. Therefore, a surgeon may be very reluctant, or at least very careful, of inserting instruments into the back of the knee joint to remove tissue. This may result in osteophytes, bone spurs and similar types of posterior soft tissue being left in place.
With known techniques, the patella is commonly everted from its normal position. When the patella is everted, the inner side of the patella is exposed and faces outward away from end portions of the femur and tibia. The outer side of the everted patella faces inward toward the end portions of the femur and the tibia. Moving the everted patella to one side of end portions of the femur and tibia tends to increase the size of the incision which must be made in the knee portion of the patient's leg.
After implants have been positioned in the knee portion of the patient's leg, it is common to check for flexion and extension balancing of ligaments by flexing and extending the knee portion with the foot above the support surface. If the ligaments are too tight medially or laterally, they can be released to obtain the desired tension. However, the checking of ligament balance by flexing and extending the leg of the patient, ignores rotational balancing of ligaments. Since the femoral implant is movable relative to the tibial implant, the stability of the knee joint is dependent upon balancing of the ligaments in flexion, extension, and rotation.
The present invention relates to a new and improved method and apparatus for use in performing any desired type of surgery on a joint in a patient's body. The joint may advantageously be a knee joint. However, the method and apparatus may be used in association with surgery on other joints in a patient's body. There are many different features of the present invention which may used either together or separately in association with many different types of surgery. Although features of the present invention may be used with many different surgical procedures, the invention is described herein in conjunction with surgery on a joint in a patient's body.
One of the features of the present invention relates to the making of a limited incision. The limited incision may be in any desired portion of a patient's body. For example, the limited incision may be in a knee portion of a leg of a patient. The limited incision may be made while a lower portion of the leg of the patient is extending downward from the upper portion of the leg of the patient. At this time, a foot connected with the lower portion of the leg of the patient may be below a surface on which the patient is supported. The limited incision may be made while the lower portion of the leg of the patient is suspended from the upper portion of the leg or while the lower portion of the leg and/or the foot of the patient are held by a support device. After the incision has been made, any one of many surgical procedures may be undertaken.
It is believed that in certain circumstances, it may be desired to have a main incision of limited length and a secondary incision of even smaller length. The secondary incision may be a portal or stab wound. A cutting tool may be moved through the secondary incision. An implant may be moved through the main incision.
Once the incision has been made, a patella in a knee portion of the patient may be offset to one side of its normal position. When the patella is offset, an inner side of the patella faces inward toward the end portions of a femur and tibia. If desired, the patella can be cut and realigned in situ, with minimal or no subluxation. Additionally, the cutting and/or realignment can be done while the knee is in flexion, which is the natural position, rather than extension.
Although any one of many known surgical procedures may be undertaken through the limited incision, down sized instrumentation for use in the making of cuts in a femur and/or tibia may be moved through or part way through the incision. The down sized instrumentation may be smaller than implants to be positioned in the knee portion of the patient. The down sized instrumentation may have opposite ends which are spaced apart by a distance which is less than the distance between lateral and medial epicondyles on a femur or tibia in the leg of the patient.
It is contemplated that the down sized instrumentation may have cutting tool guide surfaces of reduced length. The length of the cutting tool guide surfaces may be less than the length of a cut to be made on a bone. A cut on a bone in the patient may be completed using previously cut surfaces as a guide for the cutting tool.
It is contemplated that at least some, if not all, cuts on a bone may be made using light or other electromagnetic radiation, such as infrared radiation, directed onto the bone as a guide. The light directed onto the bone may be in the form of a three dimensional image. The light directed onto the bone may be a beam along which a cutting or milling tool is moved into engagement with the bone.
There are several different orders in which cuts may be made on bones in the knee portion of the leg of the patient. It is believed that it may be advantageous to make the patellar and tibial cuts before making the femoral cuts.
There are many different reasons to check ligament balancing in a knee portion of the leg of a patient. Ligament balancing may be checked while the knee portion of the leg of the patient is flexed and the foot of the patient is below the support surface on which the patient is disposed. Flexion and extension balancing of ligaments may be checked by varying the extent of flexion of the knee portion of the leg of the patient. In addition, rotational stability of the ligaments may be checked by rotating the lower portion of the leg of the patient about its central axis. Balancing of ligaments may also be checked by moving the foot of the patient sideways, rotating the lower portion of the leg of the patient, and/or moving the foot anteriorly or posteriorly.
It is believed that it may be advantageous to utilize an endoscope or a similar apparatus to examine portions of the patient's body which are spaced from the incision. It is also contemplated that images of the knee portion of the patient's leg may be obtained by using any one of many known image generating devices other than an endoscope. The images may be obtained while the patient's leg is stationary or in motion. The images may be obtained to assist a surgeon in conducting any desired type of surgery.
Balancing of the ligaments in the knee portion of a patient's leg may be facilitated by the positioning of one or more transducers between tendons, ligaments, and/or bones in the knee portion. One transducer may be positioned relative to a medial side of a knee joint. Another transducer may be positioned relative to a lateral side of the knee joint. During bending of the knee joint, the output from the transducers will vary as a function of variations in tension forces in the ligaments. This enables the tension forces in ligaments in opposite sides of the knee portion to be compared to facilitate balancing of the ligaments.
Patellar tracking may be checked by the positioning of one or more transducers between the patella and the distal end portion of the femur. If desired, one transducer may be placed between a medial portion of the patella and the distal end portion of the femur. A second transducer may be placed between a lateral portion of the patella and the distal end portion of the femur. Output signals from a transducer will vary as a function of variations in force transmitted between the patella and femur during bending of the leg.
The articular surface on the patella may be repaired. The defective original articular surface on the patella may be removed by cutting the patella while an inner side of the patella faces toward a distal end portion of a femur. The step of cutting the patella may be performed while the patella is disposed in situ and is urged toward the distal end portion of the femur by connective tissue. An implant may then be positioned on the patella.
It is contemplated that the size of the incision in the knee or other portion of the patient may be minimized by conducting surgery through a cannula. The cannula may be expandable. To facilitate moving of an implant through the cannula, the implant may be formed in two or more portions. The portions of the implant may be interconnected when the portions of the implant have been positioned in the patient's body. Although the implants disclosed herein are associated with a patient's knee, it should be understood that the implants may be positioned at any desired location in a patient's body.
An implant may be positioned in a recess formed in a bone in a patient. The implant may contain biological resurfacing and/or bone growth promoting materials. The implant may contain mesenchymal cells and/or tissue inductive factors. Alternatively, the implant may be formed of one or more materials which do not enable bone to grow into the implant.
In accordance with one of the features of the present invention, body tissue may be moved or stretched by a device which is expandable. The expandable device may be biodegradable so that it can be left in a patient's body. The expandable device may be expanded to move and/or stretch body tissue and increase a range of motion of a joint. The expandable device may be used to stretch body tissue in which an incision is to be made.
An improved drape system is provided to maintain a sterile field between a surgeon and a patient during movement of the surgeon relative to the patient. The improved drape system includes a drape which extends between the surgeon and a drape for the patient. During surgery on a knee portion of a leg of a patient, the drape system extends beneath a foot portion of the leg of a patient. It is contemplated that the drape system will be utilized during many different types of operations other than surgery on a leg of a patient.
An implant may be movable relative to both a femur and a tibia in a leg of a patient during bending of the leg. The implant may include a single member which is disposed between and engaged by end portions of both the femur and tibia. Alternatively, the implant may include a plurality of members which are disposed in engagement with each other. If desired, one of the members of the plurality of members may be secured to a bone and engaged by a member which is not secured to a bone. The implant may be secured to soft tissue in the knee portion of the patient's leg.
There are many different features to the present invention. It is contemplated that these features may be used together or separately. It is also contemplated that the features may be utilized in association with joints in a patient's body other than a knee joint. For example, features of the present invention may be used in association with surgery on vertebral joints or glenoid joints. However, it is believed that many of the features may be advantageously utilized together during the performance of surgery on a patient's knee. However, the invention should not be limited to any particular combination of features or to surgery on any particular joint in a patient's body. It is contemplated that features of the present invention will be used in association with surgery which is not performed on a joint in a patient's body.
The foregoing and other features of the invention will become more apparent upon a consideration of the following description taken in connection with the accompanying drawings wherein:
During the performance of surgery using known methods, a patient is supported on an operating table or other support surface 52 (
During this known operating procedure, an incision is made in the knee portion 58 of the leg 50 when the leg is in the extended position illustrated in dashed lines in
As the knee portion 58 is bent, the leg 50 is flexed and compresses the soft tissue of the knee portion 58 against the back of the knee joint. This makes it very difficult to access the posterior of the knee portion 58 to remove bone spurs (osteophytes), the meniscus, the posterior capsule, and/or any residual soft tissue or bone that is blocking further flexion. The catching or pinching of soft tissue in the posterior aspect of the knee portion 58 may prevent further flexion and limits the range of motion. In addition, arteries, nerves and veins are sitting just posterior of the knee joint.
Due to the lack of access to the posterior of the knee portion 58, a surgeon may be very reluctant or, at least, very careful about inserting instruments blindly into the back of the knee joint to remove tissue. This may result in osteophytes, bone spurs and similar types of posterior soft tissue being left in place.
Cuts are made on a femur and tibia with the leg 50 in the bent or flexed condition, illustrated in
Preparation for Operation
It is contemplated that various features and/or combinations of features of the present invention will be utilized during surgery on different portions of a patient's body, such as a head, trunk or limbs of a patient. Although at least some of the features of the present invention are believed particularly advantageous when utilized in association with surgery on any one of the many joints in a patient's body, it is believed that the various features and/or combination of the features of the present invention are particularly advantageous when utilized in conjunction with surgery on a knee portion of a leg of a patient. It should be understood that the various features of the present invention may be use separately or in any desired combination of features.
Surgery on the knee portion of the patient may relate to any one of many different aspects of the knee portion, such as ligaments, tendons, articular surfaces, and/or total or partial knee replacements or revisions. Although the disclosure herein frequently refers to one particular type of knee operation, that is, a total knee replacement, features of the invention may be utilized with any desired type of surgery. It is believed that it will be apparent to a person having a knowledge of knee surgery how various features of the invention may be utilized with either a full or partial knee replacement. Therefore, there has been only minimal mention herein of how the features of the invention are applicable to partial knee replacements.
When knee surgery is to be performed in accordance with one of the features of the present invention, the patient 62 (
In accordance with another of the features of the present invention, the upper portion 72 of the leg 70 can be supported above the support surface 64 by a leg support 80 (
A generally annular thigh holder 86 extends around the upper portion 72 of the leg 70 of the patient and is connected with the base 84 and stand 82. The base 84 has a portion which extends along the posterior side of the upper portion 72 of the leg 70 of the patient. The base 84 supports the upper portion 72 of the leg 70 above and spaced from the support surface 64. However, the upper portion 72 of the leg 70 could be disposed in engagement with the support surface 64 if desired.
The leg support 80 supports the leg 70 of the patient with a hip 88 of the patient hyperflexed at an angle of twenty to thirty degrees throughout the operation on the knee portion 76. The leg support 80 may have a known commercial construction or may have a construction similar to that disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 4,373,709 or U.S. Pat. No. 6,012,456. If desired, a tourniquet may be combined with the leg support 80 in a manner similar to that provided in known leg supports or in a manner similar to that disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 4,457,302.
In accordance with another feature of the invention, the lower portion 68 (
Alternatively, the foot 74 and ankle portion 86 may be moved posteriorly toward the operating table 66, from the position illustrated in
It is contemplated that the foot 74 and ankle portion 86 may be simultaneously moved in a plurality of the directions previously mentioned. If desired, the upper portion 72 of the leg 70 of the patient may be supported on a separate section of the operating table 66, in a manner similar to the disclosure in U.S. Pat. No. 5,007,912.
After a drape 90 has been positioned over the patient 62 and the operating table 66, in the manner illustrated in
When the leg 70 is in a hyperflexed condition, the included angle between the upper and lower portions 72 and 68 of the leg 70 is less than ninety degrees. The leg 70 may be flexed from the extended position of
An improved drapery system 100 (
Regardless of whether separate or integral, drape 90 and/or drape 102 can include attachments for surgical instruments such as suction, Bovie, arthroscopic equipment, etc. Drape 102 can have a large pouch to collect all fluid, body parts, blood, etc. so they do not drain all over the floor and are collected in an easily disposable fashion. In this regard, drape 102 can include a drain, with or without active suction, to remove fluid and other debris.
Drape 90 could be adhesive drape with a Betadine adhesive or a clear plastic adhesive, either with or without antimicrobial agents impregnated, which covers the skin surrounding the operative field. Drape 90 could be a two layer drape with a larger drape below which sticks to the patient or is loosely attached to the patient and a narrower surgical field drape above for two layer draping.
In the embodiment illustrated in
The improved drapery system 100 maintains a sterile field between the leg 70 and the surgeon 106 during movement of the surgeon relative to the patient 62. Thus, when the surgeon is in a seated position (
During movement of the surgeon 106 relative to the patient, for example, between the seated position of
Drape 102 and/or drape 90 has flexibility and could be provided with flexed sections or may have a large redundant area which would go down to the surgeon's knees or to the floor to maintain the sterile field. By typical sterile technique, anything below the waist level of the surgeon or the support surface is considered un-sterile. However, with drapery system 100, if drape 102 happens to drop down to the floor, it creates a contiguous sterile field and therefore, the surgeon could retrieve dropped objects from the floor if it is contained within drape 102 or drape 90. This could save a significant amount of money by eliminating the need to dispose of (or re-sterilize) fallen surgical instruments or implants.
Although the drapery system 100 has been illustrated in
Drapery system 100 can use disposable drapes or can be re-sterilizable, either in its entirety or portions thereof. Additionally, known current drape technology can be incorporated into drapery system 100. This includes the use of disposable independent drapes, ¾ sheet, disposable adherent drapes, U-drapes, disposable adhesive drapes, Betadine drapes, VELCRO attached drapes, snap, plastic snap drapes, single piece drapes, multi-drapes, two layer drapes, clear plastic drapes, independent or attached to drapes, one piece drapes with stretchable segment for extremities, arthroscopic drapes, shoulder drapes which incorporate U-drapes, square drapes, etc.
In another embodiment, drapes 90, 102 could be configured to create a mobile field. Specifically, the drapes can be made to have a surgeon's helmet attached to it and part of gown 104 attached to it so that the surgeon would literally walk into the drape system, his hands and his face would go into the drape to create a mobile surgical field attached to the patient to create even more of a sterile field. The drapery system could have laminar flow system connected to it to create sterile air coming in and then a suction coming out so it could have unidirectional airflow to further sterilize the field.
The drape system could have a tent, a cover over the top of this to create a mobile surgical field so that this could be done in emergency setting such as a military field or otherwise outdoors. Because the drape system can be provided with an attachment for flowing air in and out, maintaining extremely sterile air, the drape system could also be used for organ or tissue harvesting, such as bone harvesting under an emergency situation. The drape system could have the surgeon's gown, face mask, sterilizable hood all attached as part of it. It could be unrolled as one sterile pack adhering to the patient and rolling outward and the surgeon simply walks into the drape as does the assistant. When the procedure is complete, simply roll up the drape and throw it away, thereby maintaining all potential biohazards.
The drape could have a sterile flap where instruments could be passed through and/or a simple opening where the assistant could deliver instruments required through this field or the drape could be a flat open sheet where the assistant could bring the instruments on top of the sterile surgical field. There also may be a separate attachment for the circulating nurse.
As previously noted, drape 90 and/or drape 102 may also include an abbreviated gown 104 simply with the arms, front portion of the gown. This abbreviated gown could be a portion of drape 90, 102 so the draping system need not extend fully down to the floor. Rather, the abbreviated gown would have arm holes so that the surgeon can put his arms through the holes and the nurse would put gloves on him once they are sterilized. A provision can be made so that at least one person has an independently moveable surgical gown.
Incision
In accordance with another feature of the present invention, a limited incision 114 (
In one embodiment, the incision is made when the knee portion 76 of the leg is flexed and the lower portion 68 of the leg extends downward from the upper portion 72 of the leg in the manner illustrated in
When the knee portion 76 of the leg 70 is flexed so that the lower portion 68 of the leg is suspended at an angle of approximately ninety degrees relative to the upper portion 72 (
The benefits of having a smaller incision include improved cosmetic results, improved rehab, less dissection of muscle and soft tissue, and preservation of the quadriceps mechanism.
It is preferred to have the incision 114 located adjacent to the medial edge of the patella 120, in the manner illustrated schematically in
Although it is desired to minimize the length of the incision 114, it is contemplated that the incision may have a length of approximately twice the length of the patella. It may be desired to have the incision 114 extend from a proximal end of the tibia in the leg 70 to the epicondylar notch on the distal end portion of the femur in the leg 70. The length and location of the incision 114 may vary depending on the size of the implants to be positioned in the knee portion 76 and the location at which the implants are to be positioned. It is believed that it may be desired to have the incision 114 be smaller than the implants even though the implants must move through the incision. The visoelastic nature of the body tissue and mobility of the incision 114 enables the implants to be larger than the incision and still move through the incision.
A straight incision 114 has been illustrated in
Immediately after the incision 114 is formed, the leg 70 may be moved from the flexed condition of
After the incision 114 has been elastically expanded, a patella 120 and tissue on the lateral side of the incision may be everted in a manner illustrated in
In order to enable a relatively small incision 114 to be used for operating on bones in the knee portion 76 of the leg 70 of the patient, the patella 120 is returned back to its normal position with the inner side 122 of the patella facing inward and the outer side of the patella facing outward. As this occurs, the opening at the incision 114 contracts. The retractors are then utilized to apply force against opposite sides of the incision 114. As this occurs, the visoelastic body tissue is extended, the opening at the incision 114 is again expanded, and the patella 120 is pushed to the lateral side of the knee portion 76. This moves the patella 120 to a location offset to one side of the incision 114 in a manner illustrated in
If desired, the foregoing step of inverting the patella 120 may be omitted. The patella 120 may be left in orientations in which the inner side 122 of the patella faces inward throughout the operation. If this is done, the inner side 122 of the patella 120 may be inspected by tilting the patella from its normal orientation and/or using viewing devices, such as an endoscope. Regardless of how the inner side 122 of the patella 120 is inspected, moving the patella to the offset position of
As shown in
Retractor 121 can be made out of any suitable material, such as metallic materials typically used for surgical instruments. If retractor 121 is made of a polymer, it is contemplated that retractor 121 could be disposable. If this is done, retractor 121 may be partially or entirely formed of relatively inexpensive polymeric materials. As previously disclosed, the disposable retractors could be sharpened at one end like a Homan. Such a disposable retractor could be made of a polymer such as polyethylene, which may be malleable to a degree. Thus, the disposable refractor could be deformed to a desired shape to expose the joint as required and possibly pin the tissue directly through the malleable portion of the retractor to hold the soft tissue out of the way while one is working on the bone. This would allow enhanced exposure through a smaller incision, visualizing it through flexion and extension.
The retractors could also be a composite with some metal and some plastic with a portion of the device, flexible, malleable and locking into bone to keep the tissue out of the way while one is working on the bone. Additionally, it is contemplated that the retractors could also be heated and malleable intraoperatively. The retractors could be made of a biodegradable material and be left in position to maintain a soft tissue sleeve or exposure so as to minimize scarring the joint. Regardless of the material, the retractors could have ribs or a roughened surface to grip the tissue. The retractors could also be coupled with a balloon retractor (discussed below).
Femoral Procedure
Expansion of the incision 114 with the retractors exposes a distal end portion 124 (
The drill 128 is utilized to form a hole 130 in the center of the intercondylar notch in the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 in a known manner. The drill 128 is used to form the hole 130 while the leg 70 is in the orientation illustrated in
An epicondylar reference guide (not shown) engages the hole in the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 to enable a line parallel to an epicondylar axis peaks of the medial and lateral condyles to be inscribed on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. At this time, the leg 70 is in the orientation illustrated in
The femoral alignment guide 134 is then aligned with the epicondylar line which extends parallel to the epicondylar axis through the peaks of the lateral and medial condyles on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. The femoral alignment guide 134 is utilized to support an anterior resection guide 138 and stylus 140 (
In accordance with one of the features of the present invention, the instrumentation is down sized to enable the size of the incision 114 (
The instrumentation extends from a center portion of the femur 126 toward one side of the femur (
The femoral alignment guide 134 (
The distance between opposite ends of a known femoral alignment guide and the distance between opposite ends of a known anterior resection guide are approximately the same as or greater than the distance between the tips 144 and 146 of the lateral and medial condyles 148 and 150. The distance between opposite ends of the known femoral alignment guide and the distance between opposite ends of the known anterior resection guide are greater than the transverse dimensions of the femoral and tibial implants 286, 290 and 294 (
The incision 114 must be large enough to enable the femoral alignment guide 134 and the anterior resection guide 138 to pass through the incision. By reducing the size of the femoral alignment guide 134 and anterior resection guide 138, the size of the incision 114 can be reduced. Of course, reducing the size of the incision 118 reduces damage to body tissue of the patient 62. The femoral alignment guide 134 and the anterior resection guide 138 may be larger than the incision 114. This is because the incision 114 can be resiliently stretched and/or moved relative to the femur 126 to enable the femoral alignment guide 134 and anterior resection guide 138 to move through the incision.
The distance between opposite ends 154 and 156 of the femoral alignment guide 134 is less than the distance which a femoral implant extends across the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. Similarly, the distance between opposite ends 160 and 162 of the anterior resection guide 138 is less than the distance which the femoral implant extends across the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. The femoral alignment guide 134 and the anterior resection guide 138 both extend medially from a center portion of the femur 126. However, if the incision 114 were offset laterally of the patella 120, the femoral alignment guide 134 and the anterior resection guide 138 would extend laterally from the center portion of the femur 126. Similarly, if the incision 114 was centered relative to the patella 120, the femoral alignment guide 134 and anterior resection guide 138 would be centered relative to the femur 126.
If leg 70 is positioned as shown in
By distracting the knee joint under the influence of the weight of the lower portion 68 of the leg of the patient, the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 is exposed through the relatively small incision 114 (
In accordance with another feature of the present invention, the instrumentation is at least partially positioned between the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and body tissue of the knee portion 76 (
With prior art instrumentation, the soft tissue must be completely dissected so that the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 is fully exposed. In contrast, the instrumentation of the present invention can be at least partially positioned between the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and body tissue of the knee portion 76 (
When the femoral alignment guide 134 and anterior resection guide 138 are connected with the femur 126, central axis of the femoral alignment guide and anterior resection guide are medially offset from the central axis of the femur. Thus, the central axis of the femur 216 extends through a lateral portion, that is, left portion as viewed in
By having both the incision 114 and the instrumentation medially offset relative to the femur 126, the central portion of the instrumentation is exposed at the incision. Thus, the medial edge of the incision overlaps the medial end 156 of the femoral alignment guide 134 and the medial end 162 of the anterior resection guide 138. Similarly, the lateral edge of the incision 114 overlaps the lateral end 154 of the femoral alignment guide 134 and the lateral end 160 of the anterior resection guide 138.
In view of the foregoing, it can be seen that the leg 70 (
Once the femoral alignment guide 134 and anterior resection guide 138 have been mounted on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126, an anterior cut is made in the manner illustrated in
The guide surface 178 extends only part way across of the end portion 124 of the femur 126 (
When anterior portions of the lateral and medial condyles 148 and 150 (
The saw blade may have teeth along opposite longitudinally extending edges. The saw blade 170 and saw 172 are of the oscillating type. However, a reciprocating type saw and blade may be utilized if desired. Additionally and as later described, a milling device and associated guides can be used.
Due to the limited length of the anterior resection guide 138, the saw blade 170 is moved along the guide surface 178 to only partially complete the anterior skim cut on the end portion 124 of the femur 126. The guide surface 178 is offset to the medial side of the central axis of femur 126 (
During completion of the anterior femur (skim) cut, previously cut surfaces on the end portion 124 of the femur 126 can be used to guide the saw blade 170 (
The saw blade 170 is then moved along the previously cut surfaces on the distal end portion of the femur 126 to guide the saw blade during completion of the anterior skim cut. Utilizing cut surfaces formed during an initial portion of the anterior skim cut to guide the saw blade 170 enables the size of the anterior resection guide 138 to be minimized. Although the illustrated saw blade 170 has teeth 180 at only one end, the saw blade could also have teeth along opposite longitudinally extending edges.
By utilizing the anterior resection guide 138 to guide movement of the saw blade 170 during only an initial portion of forming the anterior skim cut on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126, the overall length of the anterior resection guide, that is, the distance between the ends 160 and 162 (
It is contemplated that the initial portion of the anterior skim cut could be made with a first cutting tool and the anterior skim cut completed with a second cutting tool. The initial portion of the anterior skim cut may be made with relatively small oscillating saw blade. The final portion of the anterior skim cut may be made with a larger reciprocating saw blade. Alternatively, a small milling cutter could be used to make the initial portion of the anterior skim cut. The final portion of the skim cut could be made with a relatively long milling cutter or saw blade. It may be desired to make the initial portion of the anterior skim cut with a chisel and to complete the anterior skim cut with either a saw blade or a milling cutter.
The illustrated anterior resection guide 138 has a slot which forms the guide surface 178. This results in the saw blade 170 being captured so that the saw blade is restrained against both up and down movement (as viewed in
During making of the anterior skim cut, with and without the anterior resection guide 138, body tissue (
After the anterior portion of the lateral and medial epicondyles have been cut away and the anterior resection guide 138 removed, a flat anterior cut surface 182 (
The flat anterior cut surface 182 (
During making of the anterior skim cut, the patient 62 (
Throughout the making of the anterior skim cut and the formation of the flat anterior cut surface 182 (
Once the anterior skim cut has been completed, a distal resection guide 186 is positioned relative to the flat anterior skim cut surface 182 (
When the distal resection guide 186 is to be connected with the resection guide stand 190, the distal resection guide is moved between the anterior skim cut surface 182 and body tissue overlying the anterior skim cut surface (
Once the distal resection guide 186 has been positioned in the desired location on the flat anterior cut surface 182, the distal resection guide 186 is secured in place with pins 196 and 198 (
The femoral alignment guide 134 and resection guide stand 190 are then separated from the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 (
The distal resection guide 186, like the anterior resection guide 138, is down sized to enable the distal resection guide to move into the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70 through a relatively small incision 114. To enable the distal resection guide 186 to move into the incision through a relatively small incision 114, opposite ends 206 and 208 (
The distal resection guide 186 is offset medially relative to the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. The incision 114 is also medially offset relative to the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. This results in the central portion of the guide surface 202 being exposed through the incision 114. The lateral and medial edges of the incision 114 overlap opposite ends 206 and 208 of the distal resection guide 186. The incision 114 also overlaps the anterior side, that is, the upper side as viewed in
During making of the distal femoral cut, the saw blade 170 moves along the guide surface 202 (
Due to the reduced size of the distal resection guide 186, the saw blade 170 (
During completion of the distal femoral cut, surfaces formed during the initial portion of the distal femoral cut are effective to guide the saw blade 170. The saw blade 170 (
The initial portion of the distal femoral cut may be made with a first cutting tool and the final portion of the distal femoral cut may be made with a second cutting. For example, the initial portion of the distal femoral cut may be made with a relatively small oscillating saw blade which can be readily inserted through the incision 114 into engagement with the distal resection guide 186. The final portion of the distal femoral cut may be made with a larger saw blade which may be of the reciprocating type. It is contemplated that the initial and/or final portion of the distal femoral cut may be made with a milling cutter. It is also contemplated that a chisel may be used to make the initial and/or final portion of the distal femoral cut.
When the distal femoral cut is completed, a flat distal end surface 209 extends across the distal end of the femur 126 (
The distal femoral cut can be formed with the patella 120 (
A femoral cutting guide 210 (
The initial portion of the femoral anterior, posterior and chamfer cuts are made by moving the saw blade 170 or other cutting tool along guide surfaces on the femoral cutting guide. Due to the relatively small size of the femoral cutting guide, the cuts cannot be completed while moving the saw blade 170 or other cutting tool along guide surfaces on the femoral cutting guide. Therefore, the femoral cutting guide 210 is separated from the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and the cuts are completed while guiding movement of the saw blade 170 or other cutting tool with cut surfaces formed during the making of the initial portions of the femoral anterior, posterior and chamfer cuts. When the femoral anterior, posterior and chamfer cuts are completed, the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 will have the known configuration illustrated in
The femoral cutting guide 210 (
Since the femoral cutting guide 210 is down sized, initial portions of the femoral anterior, posterior and chamfer cuts are made while guiding a saw blade or other cutting tool with the femoral cutting guide. These cuts are subsequently completed utilizing previously cut surfaces to guide the saw blade 170. To complete a cut in this manner, the saw blade 170 or other cutting tool is moved along the previously cut surfaces to guide the saw blade as the cuts are extended.
During the making of the initial portions of the anterior, posterior and chamfer cuts with the femoral cutting guide 210 and the subsequent completion of the cuts without the femoral cutting guide, the knee portion 76 of the leg 70 of the patient can be distracted by the weight of the lower portion 68 and foot 74 of the leg. Thus, the lower portion 68 and foot 74 of the leg 70 are suspended from the upper portion 72 of the leg in a manner illustrated in
By distracting the knee joint during the making of the femoral anterior, posterior and chamfer cuts, access to the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 is promoted and the making of the cuts is facilitated. Access to the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 is also promoted by moving the suspended lower portion 68 of the leg 70 relative to the distal end portion of the femur. The incision 114 may be moved relative to the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 by applying force to body tissue adjacent to the incision.
Tibial Procedure
As was the case for femoral preparation, the tibial procedure can be performed with the leg 70 in the position shown in
When the knee portion 76 (
It is contemplated that an external tibial alignment guide (not shown) will be utilized to align a tibial resection guide 218 (
Once the tibial resection guide 218 (
In accordance with one of the features of the present invention, the tibial resection guide 218 is relatively small so that it can be moved through a relatively small incision 114 into engagement with the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. To facilitate moving of the tibial resection guide 218 through a relatively small incision 114, the tibial resection guide 218 is smaller than implants 286 (
During positioning of the external tibial alignment guide and the tibial resection guide 218 (
During positioning of the tibial resection guide 218 on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214, the tibial resection guide is moved between the proximal end portion of the tibia and body tissue overlying the proximal end portion of the tibia. The tibial resection guide 218 is positioned relative to the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 while the incision 114 is resiliently expanded. The incision 114 is expanded by applying force against opposite sides of the incision with suitable retractors. The refractors may have a construction similar to the construction disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,308,349. Alternatively, a pneumatic refractor, such as is disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/526,949 filed Mar. 16, 2000 by Peter M. Bonutti may be used to expand the incision 114.
The tibial resection guide 218 is slid inferiorly, that is, downward (as viewed in
The tibial resection guide 218 is medially offset relative to the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. This is because the incision 114 is medially offset relative to the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. The incision 114 extends from the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 to the superior portion of the trochlear groove in the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. As was previously mentioned, the incision 114 and the instrumentation may be laterally offset relative to the femur 126 and the tibia 214.
Once the tibial resection guide 218 (
Due to the reduced size of the tibial resection guide 218 to facilitate movement of the tibial resection guide through the incision 114, the saw 172 can only form an initial portion of the proximal tibial cut as the saw blade 170 moves along the guide surface 242 of the tibial resection guide 218. To complete the proximal tibial resection cut, the tibial resection guide 218 is disconnected from the tibia 214.
Once the tibial resection guide 218 has been separated from the tibia 214, the saw blade 170 is inserted into the slit or kerf made by the saw blade during the initial portion of the proximal tibial cut. The cut surfaces which were formed during an initial portion of making the proximal tibial cut on the tibia 214 are then used to guide the saw blade 170 during completion of the proximal tibial cut. Thus, the saw blade 170 is moved along surfaces formed during the making of the initial portion of the proximal tibial cut to guide movement of the saw blade during completion of the proximal tibial cut.
It is contemplated that different cutting tools may be utilized to make the initial and final portions of the proximal tibial cut. Thus, the saw blade 170 used to make the initial portion of the tibial cut may be a relatively small oscillating blade and the saw blade used to make the final portion of the tibial cut may be a relatively long reciprocating blade. Alternatively, the initial and/or final portion of the tibial cut may be made with a milling cutter. If desired, a chisel could be utilized to make the initial portion of the tibial cut. The incision 114 may be expanded with suitable retractors during making of the tibial cut. The retractors may have any desired construction, including the construction disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,308,349. Ligaments and other body tissue adjacent to the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 may be shielded with suitable surgical instruments during making of the tibial cut.
Upon completion of the proximal tibial cut on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214, a flat proximal tibia cut surface 246 (
In order to increase exposure of the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 at the incision 218, the foot 74 and lower portion 68 of the leg 70 (
Hyperflexing the patient's leg 70 moves the proximal end portion 212 (
By hyperflexing the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70 and applying a downward (as viewed in
This enables the posterior cruciate ligament 250 (
Access to the posterior portion of the knee enables osteophytes, bone spurs and similar types of posterior soft tissue to be removed. This enables tissue which could block further flexion of the knee portion 76 to be removed. In addition, it is possible to check the collateral ligaments and other fibrous connective tissue associated with the knee.
At this time, the lower portion 68 of the leg 70 (
By varying force indicated by arrows 256 (
By moving the lower portion 68 of the leg 70 upward, the ligaments and other connective tissue between the tibia 214 and femur 126 are relaxed. This enables the lower portion 68 of the leg 70 to be rotated about its longitudinal central axis, in a manner indicated by arrows 258 in
In addition, the foot 74 can be pivoted in a clockwise direction (as viewed in
The lower portion 68 of the leg 70 can also be moved sidewise, in the manner indicated by the arrow 260 in
The illustrated instrumentation can be formed of a metal which enables the instrumentation to be sterilized and reused. For example, the instrumentation could be formed of stainless steel. However, known metal instruments are relatively heavy and bulky. This substantially increases transportation expense.
It is contemplated that it may be desired to use the instrumentation once and then dispose of the instrumentation. If this is done, the instrumentation may be partially or entirely formed of relatively inexpensive polymeric materials. Thus, the femoral resection guide 134, anterior resection guide 138, distal resection guide 186, femoral cutting guide 210, and/or tibial resection guide 218 could be formed of inexpensive polymeric materials. If this was done, the guides could be used once and disposed of without being sterilized. In addition, the polymeric guides would weigh substantially less than metal guides.
Implants
After the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 has been prepared and the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 is prepared to receive implants (
As an alternative to the above-described procedure in which patella 120 is everted or flipped to the position illustrated in
Additionally, U.S. Pat. No. 5,163,949 and progeny, such as U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,358,266 B1, 6,277,136 B1, and 6,187,023 B1, discloses various embodiments of retractors and method of dissecting tissue. These embodiments include fluid operated retractors, mechanical retractors, and combinations thereof. The retractors and methods disclosed in this line of patents, which is incorporated herein by reference, can be used for patella procedures and/or visualization while the patella is maintained in a substantially non-everted, anatomic position.
Once the femoral and tibial cuts have been made and the patella repaired, femoral and tibial implants are installed in the knee portion of the leg 70. Prior to permanently mounting of the implants in the knee portion 76 of the leg 70, trials are conducted, in a known manner, with provisional femoral and tibial implants. The provisional femoral and tibial implants are releasably positioned relative to the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. As discussed in more detail below, the provisional implants (and/or instrumentation) can be made disposable and can be combined with the cutting guides or other instrumentation so that separate, dedicated provisional implants are not required.
The provisional implants are intended to aid the surgeon 106 in assessment of the function and balance of the various ligaments. The trials enable the surgeon 106 to observe the relationship of the provisional femoral and tibial implants relative to each other during flexion and extension of the knee portion 76 of the leg 70. In one embodiment, the lower portion 68 of the leg 70 is suspended from the upper portion 72 of the leg (
The trials also enable the surgeon to check the manner in which the provisional implants interact with each other during flexion, extension, rotation, and sidewise movement. The manner in which the provisional femoral and tibial implants move relative to each other during combined bending and rotational movement of a patient's leg 70 enables a surgeon to check for the occurrence of excessive space or other undesirable situations between the provisional implants. During trials with provisional implants, the range of motion of the knee joint can be checked in both flexion/extension and rotation.
Utilizing known surgical techniques, it is very difficult, if not impossible, to check for both flexion/extension balancing, rotational balancing, and sidewise balancing during trials with provisional implants. With rotational balancing, the ligaments are balanced through multiple planes. When both flexion/extension and rotation are being checked, the surgeon can locate defects and improve the stability of the knee joint. The surgeon can assess the posterior cruciate ligament, collateral ligament balancing, and posterior capsule balancing. The surgeon can proceed with flexion/extension balancing of ligaments and rotational balancing of the ligaments. This enables the leg 70 to be examined throughout its range of motion during trials with provisional implants.
During an operation on the patient's leg 70, the surgeon can apply upward force against the foot of the patient by resting the foot 74 on the surgeon's knee 252 (
Throughout the operation on the patient's knee 76, the upper portion 72 of the patient's leg 70 is supported above the support surface 64 by the leg support 80. This causes the hip of the patient to be hyperflexed by between 20 degrees and 40 degrees. Flexing of the hip by 20 degrees to 40 degrees improves rotational positioning and alignment. It also enhances the ability of the surgeon to hyperflex the knee portion 76 or to extend the knee portion during surgery. In addition, having the upper portion 72 of the patient's leg supported above the support surface 64 by the leg support 80 improves suspension of the lower portion 68 of the leg from the upper portion 72 of the leg. It is believed that the combination of suspending the lower portion 68 of the leg 70 and having the upper portion 72 of the leg supported above the support surface 64 by the leg support 80 will enhance the ability of a surgeon to check ligament balancing in flexion/extension, and rotation during trials during which provisional femoral and tibial components are temporarily connected with the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and with the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214.
During a portion of the trials, the patella 120 may be in the normal position relative to the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. Therefore, during trials, it is possible to check tracking of the patella relative to the provisional femoral implant. This is done in order to prevent any possible interference of the patella 120 with the movement of the knee through its range of motion.
To install the trial femoral and tibial components, the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 is prepared to receive the trial tibial implant. This is accomplished by positioning a tibial trial base plate 270 on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 (
The trial femoral implant (not shown) is then placed on the distal end portion 124 of the femur. This may be done in a known manner using a femoral impactor/extractor. A trial tibial bearing insert (not shown) is then mounted on the tibial trial base plate 270 in a known manner. Once this has been done, the trial provisional implants are used during conducting of trials with flexion/extension and rotational movements of the lower portion 68 of the patient's leg. When the trials are completed, the trial provisional implants are removed in a known manner.
After completion of the trials, the tibial trial base plate 270 is pinned to the proximal end portion 214 of the tibia. A tibial punch 274 (
Once the tibial punch 274 has been advanced until it is fully seated on the base plate, the punch is removed. The tibial trial base plate 270 is then removed from the proximal end portion 214 of the tibia. Once the tibial trial base plate 270 has been removed, an opening 282 (
A tibial tray 286 (
A tibial component impactor/extractor may be used to insert the tibial tray 286 into the opening 282. Once the tibial tray 286 has been mounted on the proximal end portion 212 (
The femoral and tibial implants 286, 290, and 294 may have any one of many known constructions. For example, the femoral and tibial implants could have the construction of a knee replacement which is commercially available from Howmedica Osteonics of 359 Veterans Boulevard, Rutherford, N.J. under the designation of “Scorpio” (trademark) total knee. Rather than being a total replacement, the femoral and tibial implants could be for a partial knee replacement. Thus, the femoral and tibial implants 286, 290 and 294 could have a construction which is the same as is illustrated in U.S. Pat. No. 5,514,143. The femoral and tibial implants 286, 290 and 294 may be of either the cemented type or the cementless types.
Once the femoral component 290 has been positioned on the femur 126 and the tibial tray 286 and bearing insert 294 positioned on the tibia 214, ligament balancing is again conducted. The ligament balancing includes a check of stability of the joint in flexion, extension, and rotation. The ligament balancing check is performed with the lower portion 68 of the leg 70 suspended from the upper portion 72 of the leg. The upper portion 72 of the leg 70 is held above the support surface 64 (
Since the lower portion 68 of the leg 70 is suspended from the upper portion 72, in the manner illustrated in
The knee portion 76 may be flexed and extended, by moving the lower portion of the leg 70 along the path indicated by arrow 259 in
By manually feeling resistance to flexion, rotational and/or sideward movement of the lower portion 68 of the patient's leg 70 (
In contrast to the present invention, the majority of knee arthroplasties are done with the leg in a fixed position. Surgeons do not flex and extend through progressive intervals. As the above discussion illustrates, one aspect of the present invention involves controlling the position of the joint so that when the surgeon wants to work on the quadriceps mechanism the knee is in full extension. Similarly, when the surgeon wants to work on the tibia then he may be in more flexion, more toward 90-100°. The controlled positioning can be done in a leg alignment jig which allows reproducible holding positions that can be adjusted as desired. As previously noted, this can be achieved with electric motor, pneumatics, mechanical, or simple ratchets built on to a table, but allow precise positioning of the leg while surgeon goes from flexion to extension. There are existing leg holders, but these are very crude. Most surgeons simply use a sandbag and hold the leg in one position. This position is not precisely controlled, and therefore, somewhat variable. The soft tissue sleeve and relaxation is critical as one goes from flexion to extension, is more relaxed depending on which portion of the joint you want to expose, varying from flexion to extension. Certainly, quadriceps mechanism is the most relaxed in full extension, tighter against the femur in flexion. The tibia exposure may be improved in flexion, but controlling the specific amount of flexion/extension, locking this into position while the cuts are being performed sequentially and precisely is of significant value.
A portion of the foregoing check of ligamentous balancing may be performed with the patella 120 offset to one side of the incision 114, in the manner illustrated in
When the patella 120 is moved back to its natural position, the incision 114 closes so that there is little or no exposure of the tibial bearing insert 294 and femoral component 290 to the view of the surgeon. However, the surgeon 106 can move the lower portion 68 of the leg 70 with flexion/extension motion, indicated by the arrow 259 in
In the foregoing description, the patella 120 was repaired after making the femoral and tibial cuts and before trials. However, it is contemplated that the patella 120 may be repaired after trials and after installation of the implants 286, 290 and 294. Of course, the patella 120 may not need to be repaired and will be maintained in its original condition.
It is contemplated that fluid operated devices may be utilized to release ligaments or other tissue. The fluid operated devices may be utilized to apply force to tissue to move tissue relative to a bone, to expand the tissue, or to lengthen the tissue. For example, a balloon or bladder may be placed between tissue at the posterior of the knee portion 76 prior to mounting of the implants 286, 290 and 294. The balloon may be inflated with gas or the bladder filled with liquid to move tissue relative to the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and relative to the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. The balloon or bladder may be used to move tissue before or after making of the femoral and/or tibial cuts. The balloon or bladder may be used to move tissue before or after the trial implants are positioned in the knee portion 76. The balloon or bladder may be used to move tissue before or after the implants 286, 290 and 294 are positioned in the knee portion 76.
The balloon or bladder may be formed of biodegradable or non-biodegradable material. If the balloon or bladder is formed of biodegradable material, it may be left in the knee portion during and after closing of the incision 114. Of course, the biodegradable balloon or bladder will eventually be absorbed by the patient's body. In this regard, a narcotic or other medicament may be incorporated in the material in the balloon or the fluid used to expand the balloon. This provides a gradual time release of the medicament as the balloon degrades. Regardless of whether the device is biodegradable, capsular tightening and capsular tissue can be expanded or stretched. In the device is left in postoperatively, the balloon or bladder provides for hemostasis and maintenance of the soft tissue sleeve to improve flexion/extension.
It is contemplated that fluid operated retractors, expanders, and/or dissectors may be used to retract, expand or dissect body tissue. For example, retractors having a construction similar to any one of the constructions disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,197,971 may be utilized to release tissue at locations spaced from the incision 114. When tissue is to be released at locations where there is limited accessibility from the incision 114, a device similar to any one of the devices disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,295,994 may be utilized. It is believed that devices similar to those disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/526,949 filed Mar. 16, 2000 may be used in ways similar to those disclosed therein to move and/or release body tissue.
While the lower portion 68 of the leg 70 is suspended from the upper portion 72 of the leg and while the upper portion of the leg is held above the support surface 64 by the leg support 80, the incision 114 in the knee portion 76 of the leg 70 is closed. Prior to closing of the incision 114, the incision is thoroughly drained. Tissues in the knee portion 78 are then interconnected using a suture or other suitable devices. The soft tissues are closed in a normal layered fashion.
Review
With the exception of the procedure on the patella 120 (
The incision 114 (
Throughout the entire procedure, the drapery system 100 (
It is believed that it will be particularly advantageous to utilize down sized instrumentation in performing the foregoing procedures on the knee portion 76 of the patient. The femoral alignment guide 134 (
As was previously mentioned, it is contemplated that extramedullary and/or intramedullary instrumentation could be utilized if desired. Although it is believed that it may be preferred to use instrumentation which is anteriorly based, it is contemplated that posteriorly based instrumentation systems could be used if desired. Additionally and as described below, lateral or medial based instrumentation could be used if desired. The present invention also envisions combinations of these various instrumentations.
In the foregoing description, the saw 172 and blade 170 (
It is contemplated that either extramedullary or intramedullary instrumentation having a construction which is different than the illustrated construction could be utilized. For example, the anterior resection guide 138
The instrumentation may be entirely or partially formed of light weight polymeric materials which are relatively inexpensive. A femoral cutting guide 210 has a size which corresponds to the size of the specific femoral component 290 which is to be installed on the distal end portion 124 of a femur 126. An inexpensive femoral cutting guide 210, formed of polymeric material, may be packaged along with a femoral component 290 of the same size. After the femoral component 290 is installed, the femoral cutting guide 210 may be discarded. This would minimize investment in instrumentation and would tend to reduce the cost of handling and/or sterilizing cutting guides. The result would be a reduction in cost to the patient.
It is contemplated that the use of guide members, corresponding to the anterior resection guide 138 of
It is contemplated that emitters, receivers, and/or reflectors of computer navigation systems could be pinned or otherwise attached onto the femur 126 and tibia 214 to provide cutting positions and to facilitate ligament balancing through relatively small incisions. The computer navigation system may utilize three or four separate registers which have optical feedback to a central unit. The computer navigation system may utilize electromagnetic or photo-optical feedback.
It is contemplated that various known structures could be utilized in association with the leg 70 of the patient during performing of one or more of the procedures described herein. For example, the apparatus disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,514,143 could be connected with the leg 70 of the patient and used to control flexion and extension of the leg. Since the apparatus disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,514,143 includes separate femoral and tibial sections, it is believed that this apparatus may be particularly well adapted for use with the leg of the patient in the orientation illustrated in
The foregoing description has primarily referred to a full knee replacement. However, it is contemplated that the apparatus and procedures disclosed herein may be utilized in association with a revision or partial knee replacement. For example, the method and apparatus disclosed herein could be utilized in association with a unicompartmental knee replacement of the type disclosed in the aforementioned U.S. Pat. No. 5,514,143. The method and apparatus disclosed herein could be utilized in association with a revision of a previously installed full or partial knee replacement. It is also contemplated that the procedures disclosed herein and apparatus similar to the apparatus disclosed herein may be utilized with many different types of joints. For example, the procedures and apparatus may be utilized in association with a joint in an arm, shoulder, spine or hip of a patient.
Support Assembly
In accordance with one of the features of the invention, a support assembly 330 (
When the knee portion 76 of the leg 70 is to be distracted, the piston and cylinder assembly is operated to lower the surface 332 and foot 74 of the patient. As this occurs, the weight transferred from the foot 74 of the patient to the support surface decreases until the support surface 332 is below and spaced from the foot 74. Similarly, when the extent of distraction of the knee portion 76 is to be decreased, the piston and cylinder assembly 334 is operated to raise the support surface 332 and foot 74 of the patient.
By providing a flat support surface 332, the lower portion 68 of the leg of the patient may be rotated about its longitudinal central axis relative to the upper portion 72 of the leg of the patient when the support assembly 330 is being utilized to at least partially support the lower portion 68 of the leg of the patient. However, it is contemplated that a foot holder could be provided in place of the flat surface 332. The foot holder would have the advantage of being able to hold the foot 74 of the patient in a desired orientation relative to the upper portion 72 of the leg 70 of the patient. The foot holder could be constructed so as to have a pneumatically (or other) actuated drive to rotate the foot 74 about the longitudinal central axis of the leg 70 and/or lower portion 68 of the leg 70 of the patient.
The support surface 332 is raised and lowered by operation of the piston and cylinder assembly 334. Therefore, operation of the piston and cylinder assembly 334 is effective to move the lower portion 68 of the leg 70 of the patient in the directions of the arrow 256 in
Percutaneous Instrumentation Mounting
In accordance with another feature of the invention, it is contemplated that the size of the incision 114 may be reduced by connecting one or more of the guide members with one or more bones through the skin of the patient. For example, the anterior resection guide 138 (
For example, the distal resection guide 186 (
The distal resection guide 186 is connected with the femur 126 by the pins 196 and 198. The pins 196 and 198 extend through the distal resection guide 186 and the skin 342 into the femur 126. The pins 196 and 198 extend through the flat anterior cut surface 182 into the femur 126 and hold the distal resection guide 186 against movement relative to the femur 126.
Although a distal resection guide 186 has been illustrated in
The short leg of the L-shaped anterior resection guide 138 would be positioned adjacent to the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. The short leg of the anterior resection guide would have a guide surface aligned with the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 at a location corresponding to the location where the flat anterior cut surface 182 is to be formed. This guide surface could be of the slot or capture type illustrated in
In addition to the aforementioned guides associated with the femur 126, it is contemplated that a guide associated with the tibia 214 (
Inspection
It is contemplated that at various times during the performance of the foregoing procedures, it may be desired to inspect locations remote from the incision 114. Thus, it may be desired to visually ascertain the condition of soft tissue in the posterior of the knee portion 76. In addition, it may be desired to visually check the condition of the collateral ligaments or soft tissue adjacent to the ligaments. The inspections may be conducted before or after the making of femoral and tibial cuts, before or after trials, and/or before or after installation of the implants 286, 290 and 294.
In accordance with another feature of the invention, locations remote from the limited incision may be visually inspected. To inspect locations remote from the incision 114, a leading end portion 350 (
In order to provide the surgeon 106 with information as to how the femoral and tibial implants 286, 290 and 294 interact with tissues in the knee portion 76, the leg 70 of the patient may be bent between the flexed condition of
It is contemplated that the end portion 350 of the endoscope 352 will be moved so as to enable the surgeon 106 to view the collateral ligaments, particularly the ligament on the lateral side of the knee portion 76, during bending of the knee portion. Although the endoscope 352 is illustrated in
It is contemplated that the endoscope 352 may be inserted into the knee portion 76 of the patient at a location other than through the incision 114. Thus, if desired, a separate, very small portal or puncture type incision could be formed in the knee portion 76 of the leg of the patient at a location adjacent to a location where it is desired to visually inspect the knee portion of the patient. Although it is believed that it will be desired to inspect the knee portion 76 of the patient while there is relative movement between the femur 126 and tibia 214, it should be understood that the endoscope 352 could be utilized to inspect the knee portion 76 while the femur 126 and tibia 214 are stationary relative to each other.
Although an endoscope 352 is illustrated in
Generation of Images and Robotic Device
In accordance with another feature of the invention, during performance of surgery on a knee portion 76 of a patient's leg 70 (
Thus, during flexion and/or extension of the leg 70, video images are transmitted to the screen 364 to enable a surgeon to view images of the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 during bending of the knee portion. The video display of images may be undertaken prior to forming of the incision 114 to enable the surgeon to view the manner in which components of the knee portion 76 interact prior to surgery. After the incision 114 has been made, the images provided on the video screen 364 enable the surgeon to visually determine the relationship between the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 after the patella 120 has been moved to an offset position and prior to initiating any cuts on the bones in the patient's leg 70.
After cuts have been made on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 in the manner previously explained, the lower portion 68 of the patient's leg can be moved relative to the upper portion 72 of the patient's leg. The images provided on the video screen 364 will enable a surgeon to better understand the relationship between the femur, tibia, and ligaments in the patient's leg during preliminary checking of ligament balancing after the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 has been cut and after the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 has been cut.
During trials when trial tibial and femoral components have been temporarily connected with the femur 126 and tibia 214, the images provided at the video screen 364 will enable the surgeon to better evaluate the interaction between the trial components and body tissue in the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70. Once the trials have been completed and the femoral and tibial implants 286, 290 and 294 positioned on the femur 126 and tibia 214, the images provided at the video screen 364 will enable the surgeon to evaluate the relationship between the femoral and tibial implants.
During ligamentous balancing, images provided at the video screen 364 will indicate to the surgeon whether or not there is any undesired relative movement between the femoral and tibial implants. It is contemplated that the images be transmitted from the control unit 362 to the video screen 364 during movement of the lower portion 68 of the patient's leg 70 in any one or a combination of the directions indicated by the arrows 256, 258, 259 and 260 in
The general construction and mode of operation of the C arm fluoroscope 360 (
In accordance with still another feature of the invention, a robot 370 (
A secondary arm 390 is pivotally mounted on an outer end portion of the main arm 382. The secondary arm 390 is pivotal relative to the main arm 382 in the manner indicated by arrows 392. A mounting section 396 is rotatable about a longitudinal central axis of the secondary arm 390 and has a mounting flange which is rotatable about an axis which extends perpendicular to the longitudinal central axis of the secondary arm 390.
It is contemplated that a cutting tool, such as the saw 172, may be mounted on the mounting section 396. Controls for the robot 370 effect movement of the saw relative to the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 to form the anterior cut surface 182 on the femur and to form a distal end cut on the femur. In addition, the robot 370 moves the saw to form chamfer cuts on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126.
The robot 370 may also be utilized to move the saw to make the cuts to form the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. Thus, the robot may be utilized to form the proximal tibial cut surface 246 (
By using the robot 370 to move the saw to form the cuts on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214, the need for instrumentation, such as the femoral alignment guide 134 and anterior resection guide 138 of
The robot 370 may have any one of many different constructions. Specifically, it is contemplated that the robot 370 may have the same construction as is disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,154,717. Alternatively, the robot 370 could have the construction disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/789,621 filed Feb. 21, 2001 by Peter M. Bonutti. However, it should be understood that other known robots could be utilized if desired. For example, a robot similar to the known “Robo Doc”™ could be utilized.
It is contemplated that a computer navigation system may be used with the robot 370 to guide movement of a cutting tool, such as a saw or milling cutter, relative to the tibia and femur in the leg 70 of the patient. Two or more locating devices are connected with the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. In addition, two or more locating devices are connected to the proximal end portion of the tibia 214. The locating devices cooperate with motors and computer controls 386 for the robot 370 to provide the robot with information as to the position of the mounting section 396 and cutting tool relative to the femur 126 and tibia 214.
The locating devices may be of the reflective or energy emitting type or energy receiving type. For example, three reflectors may be pinned onto the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. Similarly, three reflectors may be pinned onto the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. Light transmitted from the robot 370 to the reflectors on the femur and tibia is reflected back to photo cells on the robot to enable the robot to determine the positions of the femur and tibia. Rather than using reflectors, energy emitting devices may be pinned onto the femur 126 and tibia 214. The energy emitting devices may emit either light or radio waves.
The above-described image guided surgery system is merely intended to be representative of the type of system that can be used with the present invention. However, it should be understood that other known image guided surgery systems, both in conjunction and independent of robotic systems, could be utilized if desired. Examples of commercially available systems include systems the Z-KAT (Hollywood, Fla.) suites, the MEDIVISION system (Oberdorf, Switzerland), the STEALTH NAVIGATOR system (Louisville, Colo.), and the ORTHOPILOT System (Tuttlingen, Gemany).
It should also be understood that the robot 370 could have any one of many different constructions. It is also contemplated that the robot 370 could interact with a surgeon and patient in many different ways. For example, the robot could have a plurality of articulate arms which are controlled by the surgeon. Images provided by the fluoroscope 360 would enable the surgeon to control the articulate arms. Locating devices connected with the femur and tibia are visible to the surgeon in images provided by the fluoroscope 360. Computer controls which respond to the locating devices provide information to the surgeon about cutting tools and/or other instruments being moved by the articulate arms. The surgeon operated controls, the articulate arms, and the fluoroscope or other imaging device may cooperate in the manner disclosed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,063,095 and 6,102,850 if desired.
It is believed that it may be desired to use a hologram to provide a three-dimensional optical image of cuts to be made. The three-dimensional image would be projected onto the end portion 124 of the femur 126 and/or onto the end portion 212 of the tibia 214. The three dimensional image may be lines indicating where the femur 126 and/or tibia 214 are to be cut.
The three dimensional image would allow a surgeon 106 to visually monitor operation of the robot 370 during the making of cuts. If there was even a small discrepancy, the surgeon 106 could interrupt operation of the robot and take corrective action. It is believed that the projecting of a three dimensional image onto surfaces to be cut will be particularly advantageous when a robotic system which has surgeon operated articulate arms is utilized. The projection of a hologram generated three dimensional image would enable a surgeon to visually determine whether or not a robotic system, similar to the system disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 6,063,095 or 6,102,850, is being operated properly.
Patellar Resection
In the foregoing description, the patella 120 was everted or flipped from its normal position to a position in which an inner side 122 of the patella faces outward (
In accordance with one of the features of the present invention and as discussed above, it is contemplated that the patella 120 will be cut and an implant positioned on the patella while the patella remains in a substantially normal position relative to the femur 126. When the patella 120 is in its normal position relative to the femur 126 (
While the patella 120 is in the normal position illustrated in
The arm 474 extends through the medially offset incision 114 and under the superior aspect 480 of the in situ patella 120. The arm 476 extends through the incision 114 and under the inferior aspect 482 of the in situ patella 120. By positioning the arm 474 under the upper end portion 480 of the patella and the arm 476 under the lower end portion 482 of the patella 120, the guide surfaces in the slot 468 are accurately aligned with the patella 120 while the patella is in its normal position relative to the femur 126 and tibia 214 (
While the in situ patella 120 is urged toward the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 by the patellar tendon 456 and the patellar ligament 458 (fibrous connective tissue), the saw 170 or other cutting tool cuts along a plane 484 (
The guide assembly 464 can include inflatable bladders as an adjunct or replacement for arms 474 and 476. These bladders would elevate the patella 120 to obtain access to inner side 122. In this regard, U.S. Pat. No. 5,163,949 and progeny, such as U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,358,266 B1, 6,277,136 B1, and 6,187,023 B1, discloses various embodiments of retractors and method of dissecting tissue. These embodiments include fluid operated retractors, mechanical retractors, and combinations thereof. The retractors and methods disclosed in this line of patents, which is incorporated herein by reference, can be used for patella procedures and/or visualization while the patella is maintained in a substantially non-everted, anatomic position.
If desired, the patella 120 may be repaired before making cuts on the femur 126 and tibia 214. Thus, immediately after making the incision 114, the patella 120 may be cut while it is disposed in its normal position. An implant may then be mounted on the patella 120. The surgically repaired patella 120 may then be moved to the offset position of
Extramedullary Tibial Instrumentation
When a tibial resection guide 500 (
The external tibial alignment guide 504 (
The foot or lower end portion of the hollow distal shaft 508 is connected with the mid-point between the palpable medial and lateral malleoli by a spring clamp 518. The spring clamp 518 is aligned with the second metatarsal and grips the outside of the ankle portion 86 (
A stylus 522 (
Although the tibial resection guide 500 has been shown in
The tibial resection guide 500 is medially offset from the external tibial alignment guide 504. This is because the incision 114 (
In accordance with a feature of the apparatus of
Since, the external tibial alignment guide 504 is maintained in position during cutting of the tibia, the saw blade 170 or other cutting tool must be angled around the proximal shaft 510 of the external tibial alignment guide 504 as the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 is cut. During movement of the saw blade 170 (
Opposite ends 534 and 536 of the tibial resection guide 500 are space apart by a distance less than two thirds (⅔) of the distance between tips of lateral and medial epicondyles 236 and 238 (
During completion of the tibial cut, the guide surface 530 on the resection guide 500 is not in position to guide the saw blade 170. Therefore, cut surfaces formed during the making of the initial portions of the tibial cut are utilized to guide the saw blade. When the tibial cut is to be completed the saw blade 170 is inserted into a slot or kerf formed in the distal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 by the saw blade 170 as it moved along the guide surface 530 and made the initial portion of the tibial cut. During completion of the tibial cut, the cut surfaces which were formed on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 during the initial portion of the tibial cut are used to guide movement of the saw blade.
The tibial resection guide 218 of
The tibial resection guide 500 may be used with a first cutting tool during making of the initial portion of the tibial cut. A second cutting tool may be used to complete the tibial cut. For example, a relatively small blade 170 of an oscillating saw 172 may be used to make the initial portion of the tibial cut. A relatively long blade of a reciprocating saw may be used to complete the tibial cut. If desired, a chisel and/or milling cutter could be used to make the initial portion and/or final portion of the tibial cut.
It is contemplated that it may be desired to set the tibial resection guide 500 (
To facilitate movement of the tibial resection guide 500 between various depths, the stylus 522 includes a drive assembly 548 (
The drive assembly 548 includes an externally threaded member which is connected with the knob 550. An internally threaded member is connected with the tibial resection guide 500. The internally threaded member engages the externally threaded member and is held against axial and rotational movement relative to the tibial resection guide 500.
After the tibial resection guide 500 has been moved to a desired position relative to the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214, a locking knob 556 is rotated to actuate a lock screw to hold the tibial resection guide 500 against movement along the proximal shaft 510 of the external tibial alignment guide 504. The pin 524 is then inserted through the tibial resection guide 500 into the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214.
Rather than moving the tibial resection guide 500 along the proximal shaft 510 of the external alignment guide 504 under the influence of force transmitted from the knob 550 through the drive assembly 548 to the tibial resection guide, the drive assembly could be connected with the knob 556. For example, the knob 556 could be connected with a pinion gear of a rack and pinion drive arrangement. The rack portion of the drive arrangement could be mounted on the proximal shaft 510. If this was done, rotation of the knob 556 would cause the rack and pinion gear set to move the tibial resection guide along the proximal shaft 510 through a distance which is a function of the extent of rotation of the knob 556. The stylus 552 would be connected to the tibial resection guide 500 and would engage the proximal end of the tibia 214 to indicate when the tibial resection guide 500 had moved to a desired position relative to proximal end portion 212 of the tibia.
It is contemplated that the stylus 522 could be eliminated if desired. The tibial resection guide 500 could be positioned by sliding a thin member, such as a blade, beneath tissue overlying the proximal end portion 212 of the femur 214. A reference surface on the tibial resection guide 500 would then be moved into engagement with the blade or other thin member. The reference surface may be disposed on the upper (as viewed in
If desired a hook or sickle shaped locating member could be extended from the tibial resection guide 500 to position the tibial resection guide relative to the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. When the incision 114 and tibial resection guide 500 are medially offset relative to the tibia 214, the locating member would extend along the medial side of the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia. This would enable the stylus 522 to be eliminated.
It is contemplated that retractors may be mounted on the proximal shaft 510 of the external tibial alignment guide 504. The retractors engage opposite sides of the incision. The retractors are effective to expand the incision 114 and/or maintain the incision in a desired position relative to the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214.
Cannula
In accordance with another feature of the invention, access to the interior of the knee portion 76 of the leg 70 may be obtained through a cannula 564 (
The incision 114 is formed with a relatively short length in the manner previously described herein. The cannula 564 has an initial size, illustrated in
Compact cutting tools, similar to those utilized for arthroscopic, endoscopic, or fiber optic assisted surgery may be at least partially moved through a passage 566 (
The cannula 564 is advantageously expandable to further stretch the viscoelastic tissue of the knee portion 76. Of course, expanding the cannula 564 increases the size of the passage 566 to enable a relatively large object to pass through the passage. Thus, the cannula 564 may be expanded to facilitate movement of the implants 286, 290 and 294 through the cannula. The leg 70 is in the position shown in
It is contemplated that the expandable cannula 564 may have many different known constructions. The illustrated cannula 564 is formed of elastomeric material and has the same construction as is disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 08/470,142 filed Jun. 6, 1995 by Peter M. Bonutti, et al. and having a disclosure which corresponds to the disclosure in U.S. Pat. No. 5,961,499. It should be understood that the cannula 564 could have a different construction, for example, a construction similar to the constructions disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 3,811,449 or 5,183,464.
The cannula 564 can be expanded in many different ways other than under the influence of force transmitted directly to the cannula from an object moving through the cannula. For example, the cannula may be expanded by force transmitted from an implant 286, 290 and/or 294 to the cannula. The cannula 564 may be expanded by inserting tubular members into the cannula. Alternatively, fluid pressure could be used to expand the cannula 564 in the manner disclosed in the aforementioned Bonutti, et al. patent application Ser. No. 08/470,142 filed Jun. 6, 1995.
Rather than being expanded by inserting the expandable cannula 564 into the incision 114, the incision may be expanded by utilizing pneumatic retractors. The pneumatic retractors may have a construction similar to the construction disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,163,949. By utilizing the expandable cannula 564 or the expandable pneumatic retractors, force can be applied against opposite sides of the incision 114 to stretch the viscoelastic material disposed adjacent to opposite sides of the incision. This will result in the relatively small incision 114 being expanded to accommodate relatively large surgical instruments and/or implants.
Although a single incision 114 is illustrated in
Implant with Interconnectable Portions
In order to enable surgery on a knee portion 76 of a patient's leg 70 to be conducted through an incision 114 of relatively small size, the implant may advantageously be formed in two or more portions (
As the portions of the implant are sequentially moved through the incision 114, they are positioned in engagement with one or more of the bones, that is, the femur 126 and/or the tibia 214 in the leg 70 of a patient. After the plurality of portions of the implant have been moved through the incision 114 and positioned in engagement with the femur 126 and/or tibia 214, the portions of the implant are interconnected to form a unitary implant. If desired, the portions of the implant are moved through the incision 114 and interconnected while the leg of the patient is in the position illustrated in
It is contemplated that the portions of the implant may be interconnected, while they are disposed in the patient's body and in engagement with either the femur 126 and/or tibia 214, in many different ways. For example, the portions of the implant may be bonded together to form a one piece implant. The portions of the implant may be bonded together by the application of energy in anyone of many different forms to a joint between portions of the implant. For example, ultrasonic energy could be applied to the implant. Alternatively, heat could be directly applied to the implant. If desired, a laser could be utilized to effect bonding of separate portions of the implant together.
It is also contemplated that the separate portions of the implant could be mechanically interconnected. This could be done with a fastener which extends between portions of the implant. Alternatively, a retainer member such as a rod or bar could extend between portions of the implant. Regardless of how the portions of the implant are interconnected, the portions of the implant are interconnected after they have been moved into the patient's body.
In the embodiment of the invention illustrated in
The specific implant 290 illustrated in
The heated material of the two portions 572 and 574 of the implant 290 are then pressed together at the joint 576 to form a bond between the two portions of the implant. As this occurs, there is a fusing of the material of the portion 572 of the implant 290 with the material 574 of the implant. This fusing together of the two portions 572 and 574 occur in the patient's body and results in the formation of a one piece unitary implant 290.
Rather than being formed of a polymeric material, it is contemplated that the two portions 572 and 574 of the implant could be formed of metal and have a polymeric layer on a side of the metal toward the femur 126. This would result in the layer of polymeric material being disposed in engagement with the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and the metal forming the femoral component 290 facing toward the tibia 214 for engagement with the tibial bearing insert 294 (
When the two portions 572 and 574 of the femoral implant 290 are to be interconnected by fusing together sections of polymeric material which form the portions 572 and 574 of the implant or sections of polymeric material which are disposed on layers of metal forming part of the portions 572 and 574 of the implant 290 to be interconnected, it is contemplated that they may be interconnected in many different ways. One way in which polymeric material on the portions 572 and 574 of the femoral implant 290 may be interconnected is the same as is disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/737,380 filed Dec. 15, 2000 by Peter M. Bonutti, et al. This patent application contains a disclosure which corresponds to the disclosure in U.S. Pat. No. 6,059,817.
The two portions 572 and 574 of the implant 290 (
The implant 290 is connected with the femur 126. However, it is contemplated that a tibial implant could be formed as a plurality of separate portions which are interconnected when they are in the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70. It should be understood that the implant 290 could be formed of more than two portions. For example the implant could be formed with four separate portions which are interconnected in the patient's body. Although the implant 290 is to be used in a knee portion of a patient's body, it is contemplated that implants used at other portions of a patient's body could be interconnected in the patient's body.
In the embodiment of the invention illustrated in
For example, a first component of an implant may be connected with a femur 126 in a patient's body. A second component may be connected with a tibia 214 in the patient's body. The two components are interconnected, in the patient's body, after they have been connected with the femur and tibia.
Transducer for Ligament Balancing
After the femoral component 290 and tibial components 286 and 294 of the implant had been positioned in the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70, the ligaments are balanced in flexion, extension, and rotation in the manner previously described. It should be understood that even though the implants have not been shown in
In accordance with one of the features of the invention, during ligament balancing, tension forces in fibrous connective tissue such as collateral ligaments 590 and 592 (
In accordance with another one of the features of the invention, transducers are positioned between one or more bones in the knee portion 76 of the leg 70 of the patient. The transducers enable tension forces in ligaments 590 and 592 to be compared. The transducers may be used to determine the magnitude of the tension forces in the ligaments 590 and 592.
Thus, a first or lateral transducer 596 (
The computer 600 (
It is contemplated that the leg 70 of the patient will be moved between the flexed condition of
In addition to checking the tension in the ligaments 590 and 592 during movement of the leg 70 of the patient between flexed and extended conditions, it is contemplated that the tension in the ligaments 590 and 592 will be compared during the application of rotational forces to the lower portion 68 of the knee of the patient. Thus, forces tending to rotate the lower portion 68 of the leg of the patient in the direction of the arrow 258 in
Although the transducers 596 and 598 have been illustrated schematically in
It is contemplated that the transducers 596 and 598 could have many different constructions. However, in the illustrated embodiment of the invention, the transducers 596 and 598 are pneumatic transducers. Thus, the lateral transducer 596 (
The transducers 596 and 598 are disposed between the femur 126 and the tibia 214. Although it should be understood that the femoral implant 290 and tibial tray 286 and bearing 294 have not been illustrated in
A conductor 604 is provided to transmit an output signal from the lateral transducer 596 to the computer display 601 (
It is contemplated that the transducers 596 and 598 could have many different constructions including any one of the constructions disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,667,520 or in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/483,676 filed Jan. 14, 2000 by Peter M. Bonutti and having a disclosure corresponding to the disclosure in U.S. Pat. No. 5,269,785. The transducers 596 and 598 may be formed of a material which is biodegradable or a material which is non-biodegradable.
Although the illustrated transducers 596 and 598 (
It should be understood that the transducers 596 and 598 could be used to measure and/or compare tension in the ligaments 590 and 592 immediately after making the incision 114. In addition or alternatively, the transducers 596 and 598 could be used to measure and/or compare tension in the ligaments 590 and 592 during trials with provisional components. Of course, the transducers 596 and 598 can be used to measure and/or compare tension in the ligaments after the implants 286, 290 and 294 have been mounted in the knee portion 76.
In the embodiment of this invention illustrated in
For example, the transducer 596 could be positioned between the ligament 590 and lateral sides of the femur 126 and/or tibia 214. Similarly, the transducer 598 could be positioned between the ligament 592 and medial sides of the femur 126 and/or tibia 214.
It is contemplated that transducers, similar to the transducers 596 and 598, could be utilized to determine variations in tension in ligaments and/or tendons other than the ligaments 590 and 592. For example, transducers could be utilized to determine the tension in the patellar tendon 456 (
In addition to providing outputs which are a function of variations in tension in ligaments and/or tendons, the transducers 596 and 598 may be utilized to apply force against the femur 126 and tibia 214. When this is to be done, fluid under pressure is conducted to either or both of the transducers 596 and/or 598. An increase in fluid pressure conducted to the transducers 596 and 598 is effective to expand containers or bladders in the transducers.
The fluid pressure force applied against the transducers 596 and/or 598 is transmitted to the femur 126 and tibia 214. This force may be used to stretch the collateral ligaments 590 and 592 and/or other body tissue. If it is desired to stretch one of the ligaments 590 or 592 to a greater extent the other ligament, the fluid pressure transmitted to one of the transducers 596 or 598 would be greater than the fluid pressure transmitted to the other transducer. The force transmitted to the femur 126 and tibia 214 is indicated at the displays 61 and 601.
It is contemplated that the transducers 596 and 598 will be removed before the limited incision 114 is closed. However, if it is desired, the transducers 596 and 598 may be left in place and utilized after the incision 114 is closed. When this is to be done, the transducers 596 and 598 may advantageously be formed of biodegradable material. By leaving the transducers 596 and 598 in place after the incision 114 is closed, the tension in the ligaments 590 and 592 may be compared during therapy. If desired, one or both ligaments 596 and/or 598 could be conducting fluid pressure to one or both transducers 596 and/or 598 during therapy.
Inlaid Implant—Femur
In the embodiment of the invention illustrated in
It is contemplated that rather than enclosing the end portions of the femur and tibia with implants, the implants could be inlaid into the end portion of the femur and/or tibia. When an implant is to be inlaid into the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 (
A guide 620 (
Once the recess 610 has been formed using the milling cutter 614 in the manner illustrated schematically in
The outer surface 628 on the implant 626 cooperates with an articular surface on a tibia 214 in the same general manner as the original articular surface area removed by the milling cutter 614. Of course, the outer surface 628 of the implant 626 is free of defects that made it necessary to replace the corresponding area on the articular surface 616 of the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. The outer surface 628 of the implant 626 may engage an articular surface formed by the boney material of the tibia 214. Alternatively, the outer surface 628 of the implant 626 may engage the surface of an implant disposed on the tibia 214.
During recovery of the patient, the naturally occurring surface 616 on the femur 126 and the implant 626 may both be load bearing. By having the implant 626 surrounded by load bearing natural bone, the implant is held in place on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 26. In addition, the magnitude of the load which must be transmitted through the implant 626 is minimized.
The implant 626 could have any desired construction. Thus, the implant could be formed of a polymeric material or it could be formed of a metallic material. However, in accordance with one of the features of the invention, the implant 626 is formed of a material which promotes biological resurfacing and the growth of bone from the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 into the implant to fill the recess 610 with new bone growth. The implant 626 may also be at least partially formed of material which promotes the growth of cartilage or other tissue over the implant.
The implant 626 may be formed with a non-living three dimensional scaffold or framework structure on which bone growth promoting materials, such as bone morphogenetic proteins, are disposed. The three dimensional framework or platform on which the bone growth promoting materials are disposed may be formed of either a biodegradable or a non-biodegradable material. When the scaffold or framework structure is formed of a non biodegradable material, the bone from the distal end portion 124 will grow through the scaffold so that the scaffold becomes embedded in new bone growth. The scaffold may be formed of a porous metal or ceramic material. When the scaffold is formed of a bio-degradable material, the scaffold will eventually degrade and be absorbed by body tissue.
The scaffold may be formed of a mesh or a felt like material, or a porous material similar to coral. The scaffold forms a growth supporting matrix to support cellular migration from the boney material of the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 into the implant 626. If the scaffold or platform is made of a bio-degradable material, then the scaffold or platform degrades and disappears after a period of time. It is contemplated that the scaffold could be formed of a bio-degradable material such as polyglycolic acid or polylactic acid. If desired, the scaffold or framework could be formed of fibrous connective materials such as portions of ligaments, tendons and/or bones obtained from human and/or animal sources. The scaffold could be formed of collagen. The scaffold may be formed of submucosal tissue.
The scaffold holds bone growth inducing materials and may include bone fragments to which tri-calcium phosphate, an antibiotic, hydroxyapatiate, allografts, autografts, and/or any other polymeric has been added. It is believed that it will be particularly advantageous to provide a bone growth morphogenetics protein in the implant 626 to promote the growth of bone into the implant. The scaffold may hold cultured and/or noncultured cells which promote biological resurfacing.
The matrix or scaffold for the implant 626 may contain tissue inductive factors and/or cells. The cells may be mesenchymal cells which are introduced into the scaffold in the operating room. Thus, the matrix or scaffold may be either biodegradable or non-biodegradable and may be constructed at a location remote from an operation. After the scaffold has been transported to the operating room the mesenchymal cells may be introduced into the scaffold.
It is contemplated that the matrix or scaffold for the implant 626 may contain stem cells and/or fetal cells. The stem cells and/or fetal cells may be introduced into either a biodegradable or non-biodegradable matrix or scaffold in the operating room. It is contemplated that tissue inductive factors may be provided in the matrix or scaffold along with any desired type of precursor cells.
The matrix or scaffold for the implant 626 may contain osteoinductive materials. The implant 626 may contain osteoblasts or osteoclast cells or their precursors. The implant 626 may also contain platlet matrix centrifuged from blood in a manner similar to that described in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/483,676, filed Jan. 14, 2000 by Peter M. Bonutti. The matrix or scaffold for the implant 626 may be formed of allograft bone or collagen. Cartilage may be used to form the scaffold or matrix. The scaffold or matrix for the implant 626 may have a layered construction with the layers being formed of different materials. Each of the layers of the scaffold or matrix forming the implant 626 may be impregnated with a different material. For example, precursor cells may be provided in one layer and bone morphogentic protein may be provided in another layer.
It is contemplated that submucosal tissue may be used to form the scaffold for one or more of the layers of the implant 626. The submucosal tissue may be prepared in a manner similar to the manner disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,755,791. The various layers of the implant 626 may be assembled in the operating room.
The implant 626 may be formed of multiple tissue fragments. Thus, a tissue press, similar to the tissue presses disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/602,743 filed Jun. 23, 2000, by Peter M. Bonutti and having a disclosure which corresponds to the disclosure in U.S. Pat. No. 5,662,710 may be utilized to shape the implant to a desired configuration.
The implant 626 may be formed to have any one of a plurality of different sizes and configurations. The implant may be shaped to the desired configuration at a location remote from an operating room and transported to the operating room. Alternatively, the implant 626 could be cut to the desired shape in the operating room.
By providing a substantial number of implants of different sizes in the operating room and/or by cutting an implant to obtain a desired configuration, it is possible for a surgeon to make a recess 610 to a shape which corresponds to a defective area on a portion of the femur 126. An implant 626 having the configuration of the particular recess can then be provided. This enables the surgeon to remove a relatively small defective area of the bone forming the articular surface on the femur 126 and to minimize the size of the implant 626.
It is believed that it will be desired to provide a series of implants of different sizes ranging from a relatively small size to a relatively large size. In addition, it is believed that it will be desired to provide a plurality of guides 620. The guides 620 will have surfaces to guide movement of the milling cutter 614 or other cutting tool to form a recess 610 of a size corresponding to any one of the sizes of the implants in the series of implants. Thus, the plurality of guides 620 would be provided with each guide having guide surfaces corresponding to the configuration of an implant of a different size.
The scaffold or base of the implant 626 may be formed of a porous bio-degradable material. The porous bio degradable material provides a matrix for demineralized bone, collagen, bone morphogenetic protein, growth factors, and autogenous bone marrow. In addition, progenitor cells, stem cells and/or fetal cells may be disposed on the scaffold. Some non tissue-derived components may include coralline-based HA (ProOsteon), antibiotics, calcium sulfate, calcium and phosphorus oxide rich amorphous glass, anti-inflammatories, and bovine fibrillar collagen. The resulting material will have osteoinductive and osteoconductive qualities. Cortical cancellous bone chips which are freeze dried may be provided in the implant 626. In addition, demineralized bone matrix may be provided in the implant 626.
The implant 626 may be secured in the recess 610 with a suitable adhesive. There are many different known adhesives which may be used. Fibrin can be used as an adhesive, either in a natural state or after being compressed, to hold material together and to hold the implant 626 in the recess 610.
It is contemplated that the patient's leg 70 may be in the position illustrated in
The drapery system 100 of
Although it is believed that it will be preferred to have the patient's leg 70 in the position illustrated in
The foregoing description of the implant 626 has assumed that the implant is to be positioned in the femur 126 in a leg of a patient. However, the implant 626 could be positioned in any desired bone in a patient's body. The implant 626 could be positioned at a location remote from an articular surface of a bone. The implant 626 may be positioned on a bone in ways other than positioning the implant in a recess similar to the recess 610.
Inlaid Implant—Tibia
The implant 626 is illustrated in
The recess 642 is surrounded by an articular surface 644 of naturally occurring bone. Thus, the articular surface 644 is not defective and extends around the recess 642. It should be understood that the extent of the articular surface 644 around the recess 642 could be substantially greater than is illustrated in
The recess 642 is formed with the milling cutter 614 (
The implant 640 (
Of course, the articular surface area on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 cooperates with articular surface areas on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 (
It is contemplated that it may be preferred that the implant 640 contain bone growth promoting materials and/or materials which promote biological resurfacing. These bone growth promoting materials would promote growth of bone from the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 into the recess 642. This would result in the recess 642 being filled with new bone growth. The biological resurfacing materials would promote the growth of naturally occurring tissues on the implant 640.
The implant 640 may include a three dimensional scaffold or framework structure formed of either a biodegradable material or a non-biodegradable material. Osteoinductive and/or osteoconductive materials may be disposed on this framework or platform. The scaffold may be formed of cortical bone, cartilage submucosal tissue, or other materials.
The matrix or scaffold for the implant 640 has interstitial spaces which contain material which promotes the growth of bone from the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 into the matrix or scaffold. The bone growth materials may include bone morphogenic protein, factors that stimulate migration of cells, anti-inflamatories and/or immuno suppressants. Collagen, fribin, osteoindctive materials, progenitor cells, and/or tissue inductive factors may be disposed on the platform. The implant 640 may contain cortical cancellous bone chips or demineralized bone matrix. It may be preferred to form the outer surface of the implant 640 of materials which promote biological resurfacing.
When the implant 640 is formed with a biodegradable three dimensional scaffold or matrix, it is contemplated that there will be cellular migration and growth of bone from the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 into the scaffold or matrix. The scaffold or matrix will then degrade and disappear as material of the scaffold or platform hydrolyzes. However, if the matrix or scaffold is made of a non-biodegradable material, it is contemplated that the scaffold will become embedded in the bone growth from the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 into the recess 614. The scaffold, whether biodegradable or non biodegradable, may be impregnated with mesenchymal cells.
The implant 640 on the tibia has the same construction as the implant 626 on the femur. However, the implant 640 on the tibia could have a construction which is different than the construction of the implant 626 on the femur.
It is contemplated that the patient's leg will be in the position illustrated in
Layered Implant
A multi layered inlaid implant 670 for use in biological resurfacing is schematically illustrated in
The implant 670 is formed by a plurality of layers. The specific implant 670 illustrated in
The inner or base layer 678 is disposed in engagement with the bone 674. The inner layer 678 may be formed of bone growth promoting materials which promote migration of bone cells from the bone 674 to the base layer 678. New bone growth into the base layer 678 will interconnect the base layer and the bone 674. The base layer 678 may contain cortical cancellous bone power or chips and/or demineralized bone matrix, bone morphogenic protein, anti inflammatories and/or immuno suppressants may be disposed in the base layer 678. An antibiotic, hydroxyapatiate, tricalcium phosphate and/or polymers and copolymers may also be included in the base layer 678.
The outer layer 680 may be formed of cartilage. Embryonal cells, fetal cells, and/or stem cells may be provided in the outer layer 680. The outer layer 680 may be formed of submucosal tissue. The outer layer 680 promotes biological resurfacing of a portion of the bone 674 where the implant 670 is disposed.
It is contemplated that the recess 672 may be formed in the bone 674 at a location where there is a defect in an articular surface on the bone. However, it is also contemplated that the recess 672 in a position in a portion of the bone 674 where there is no articular surface.
It is contemplated that the patient's leg will be in the position illustrated in
Implant
An improved implant 690 is illustrated in
The base 692 (
When the implant 690 is positioned on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214, the implant is moved along a path which extends parallel to a longitudinal central axis of the projection 700. The path of movement of the implant 690 onto the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 is indicated by an arrow 707 in
As the implant 690 is moved into position on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214, a downwardly extending flange 708 connected with the main section 706 moves into engagement with an outer side surface area on the tibia 214 as the main section 706 of the implant 690 moves into engagement with flat proximal end surface 710 on the tibia 214. Once the inner side of the main section 706 has been pressed firmly against the flat end surface 710 on the tibia 214 and the projection 700 is moved to the position illustrated in
It is contemplated that the base 692 of the implant 690 may be formed of metal. For example, the base 692 may be formed of porous tantalum. Of course, the base 692 could be formed of a different material if desired. Thus, the base 692 could be formed of a polymer or copolymer if desired. The articular layer 694 is formed of a smooth polymeric material which engages in articular surface on a femur.
It is contemplated that the patient's leg will be in the position illustrated in
Expandable Devices
In accordance with another feature of the invention, one or more expandable devices 720 and 722 (
The expandable devices 720 and 722 may be inserted into the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70 one or more days before either a partial or full knee replacement operation is to be undertaken. Before the surgery is initiated, the expandable device 720 may be expanded to stretch skin 342, the joint capsule, and other tissue in the anterior of the knee portion 76. The viscoelastic body tissue is resiliently stretched by the expandable device 720 in the general area where the limited incision 114 (
The incision 114 is subsequently made in the body tissue which has been resiliently stretched by the expandable device 720. After the surgery on the patient's leg 70 has been completed, for example, after a full or partial knee replacement in accordance with
The expandable devices 720 and 722 may be resilient balloons which are inflated by a gas, such as air, or resilient bladders which are expanded under the influence of a liquid, such as saline solution. The resilient expandable devices 720 and 722 may be formed of a biodegradable material or a non-biodegradable material. It is contemplated that if the expandable devices 720 and 722 are to be left in the patient's body, they may advantageously be formed of a biodegradable material. However, if it is contemplated that when the expandable devices are to be removed from the patient's body during or after surgery, the expandable devices may be formed of a non-biodegradable material.
Rather than being inserted into the knee portion 76 prior to formation of the incision 114, the expandable devices 720 and 722 (
For example, the expandable device 720 may be resiliently expanded to stretch the patellar ligament 458 (
The expandable device 722 (
Expansion of the expandable device 722 is effective to move arteries, nerves and veins in the posterior of the knee portion 76 away from the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 prior to making of the femoral and/or tibial cuts (
It should be understood that the expandable device 722 may have a configuration which is different from the configuration illustrated in
After the femoral component 290 and tibial tray 286 and tibial bearing insert 294 have been positioned in the knee portion 726 of the patient's leg 70, the expandable devices 720 and 722 may be utilized to assist the surgeon during ligament balancing. The expandable devices 720 and 722 will also assist the surgeon in obtaining a full range of motion of the knee portion 76. Thus, the expandable devices 720 and 722 may be expanded, under the influence of fluid pressure, to effect ligament releases or to move tissue out of an interfering relationship with relative movement between the femur 126 and tibia 214.
The expandable devices 720 and 722 may be resiliently expanded under the influence of fluid pressure conducted through conduits to the expandable devices. If the expandable devices 720 and 722 are inserted after the incision 114 is formed in the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70, the conduits for conducting fluid to and from the expandable devices 720 and 722 may extend through the incision. However, if the expandable devices 720 and 722 are inserted prior to making of the incision 114, the conduits for conducting fluid to and from the expandable devices may extend through small portals or stab wounds formed in the knee portion of the patients leg. It should be understood that the conduits for conducting fluid to and from the expandable devices 720 and 722 may extend through small secondary incisions spaced from the main incision 114 even though the expandable devices 720 and 722 are positioned in the knee portion 76 after making the main incision.
The small portals or stab wounds which form secondary incisions are spaced from the location where the main incision 114 is formed. Thus, the conduit for conducting fluid to and from the expandable device 722 may extend through a portal or stab wound formed in the posterior portion of the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70. Before they are expanded, the contracted expandable devices 720 and 722, are very small and flexible. The contracted expandable devices 720 and 722 have an appearance similar to a collapsed balloon. The contracted expandable devices are easily moved through the small secondary incisions.
It is contemplated that the expandable devices 720 and 722 may be left in the knee portion 76 of a patient's leg 70 after the incision 114 has been closed. If this is done, the expandable devices 720 and 722 may be utilized to obtain a full range of motion of the patient's knee 76 during therapy and/or recovery of the patient after the incision has been closed. If the expandable devices 720 and 722 are formed of a non-biodegradable material, it may be desirable to remove the expandable devices after the incision 114 has been closed. If the expandable devices 720 and 722 are formed of a biodegradable material, they do not have to be removed after the incision has been closed. It is contemplated that the expandable devices 720 and 722 may be contracted by piercing the skin 342 and puncturing the expandable devices.
It is contemplated that it may be desired to form the expandable devices 720 and 722 (and/or the conduits for inflating expandable devices 720 and 722) of a biodegradable material which is absorbable by the patient's body. If this is done, the expandable devices 720 and 722 may be formed of polyglycolic acid, polylactic acid, or combinations of these materials. It is contemplated that the expandable devices 720 and 722 could be formed of materials which include hyaluronic acid, catgut material, gelatin, cellulose, nitrocellulose, collagen or other naturally occurring biodegradable materials. Although it is believed that it would be preferred to form the expandable devices 720 and 722 of biodegradable materials so that they can be left in the patient's body and hydrolyzed so as to be absorbed by the patient's body, it is contemplated that the expandable devices 720 and 722 could be made of a non biodegradable material if desired. The resiliently expandable devices 720 and 722 may have any of the constructions disclosed in U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,163,949; 5,454,365 and 5,514,153. Of course, the resiliently expandable devices 720 and 722 could have a different construction if desired.
Obtaining Range of Motion
After the implants 286, 290 and 294 have been positioned on the femur 126 and tibia 214 in the manner illustrated schematically in
Although it is believed that the expandable devices 720 and 722 of
The expandable device 730 may be a balloon or bladder which is made of resilient material. When fluid pressure in the expandable device 730 is increased, the expandable device is expanded from a collapsed condition to an extended condition. The resilient material of the expandable device 730 may or may not be stretched when the expandable device 730 is expanded.
The expandable device 730 may be moved posteriorly of the implants 286, 290 and 294 so as to engage tissue in the posterior portion of the patient's knee. Alternatively, the expandable device 730 may be positioned between the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. It is contemplated that the patient's leg 70 will be in the position illustrated in
When the expandable device 730 is moved to the posterior of the patient's knee portion 76, expansion of the expandable device 730 applies pressure against tissue in the posterior portion of the patient's knee. This results in movement of body tissue away from the implants 286, 290 and 294. Assuming that body tissue in the posterior of the patient's knee portion 76 is interfering with the range of relative movement between the implants 286, 290 and 294, applying pressure against the body tissue in the posterior of knee portion will move the body tissue away from the implants to enable the range of motion to be increased.
Expansion of the expandable device 730 is effective to move and stretch body tissue, such as the joint capsule, ligaments, tendons, skin or other tissue associated with the posterior portion of the patient's knee. Space is established between the distal end portion 120 of the femur 126 and body tissue. Space is also established between the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 and body tissue. Since the body tissue is moved and stretched by expansion of the expandable device 730, a portion of the space tends to remain even though the visocelastic body tissue retracts when fluid is conducted from the expandable device 730 and the size of the device decreases.
The expandable device 730 may be left in place in the posterior of the patient's knee portion 76 after the incision 114 is closed. A conduit 734 connected with the expandable device 730 would extend through the closed incision 114 to enable fluid to be conducted to and from the expandable device 730. Therefore, after the incision 114 has been closed, the expandable device 730 can be expanded to increase the range of movement of the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70. After fluid has been conducted from the expandable device through the conduit 734, the size of the expandable device is reduced by exhausting fluid through the conduit. The reduced size of the expandable device enables the conduit 734 to be pulled outward, away from the knee portion 76, to pull the expandable device 730 through a very small opening in the closed incision.
If desired, the expandable device 730 could be formed of a biodegradable material and left in the posterior of the knee portion 76. The conduit 734 could be formed of a non biodegradable material and pulled from the opening in the incision after the expandable device 730 has at least started to degrade. Of course, the conduit 734 could also be biodegradable.
Rather than applying force against body tissue at the posterior of the knee portion 76, the expandable device 734 may be utilized to apply force against the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and against the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. This force would tend to stretch or release ligaments or other fibrous connective tissue connected with the femur 126 and tibia 214. This force would also stretch the joint capsule, collateral ligaments 590 and 592 (
When this is to be done, the expandable device 730 (
Once the expandable device 730 has been utilized to apply an upwardly directed force (as viewed in
In
Although a single expandable device 730 is illustrated in
It is contemplated that different pressures may be conducted to the expandable devices in different positions in the knee portion 76. For example, a relatively low fluid pressure may be conducted to the first expandable device 730 in the posterior of the knee portion 76 to move and/or stretch body tissue with a limited force. A relatively high fluid pressure may be conducted to the second and third expandable devices 730 disposed between the femur 126 and tibia 214 to effect relative movement between the femur and tibia.
If desired, a higher fluid pressure could be conducted to one of the expandable devices 730 disposed between the femur 126 and tibia 214 than the other expandable device. For example, a higher fluid pressure may be conducted to the second expandable device 730 disposed between lateral portions of the femur 126 and tibia 214 than to the third expandable device 730 disposed between the medial portions of the femur and tibia. Alternatively, a higher fluid pressure may be conducted to the third expandable device 730 disposed between medial portions of the femur 126 and tibia 214 than to the second expandable device 730 disposed between lateral portions of the femur 126 and tibia 214.
When a plurality of expandable devices 730 are used, the expandable devices may be made of the same material or different materials. For example, the first expandable device 730 in the posterior of the knee portion may be formed of a biodegradable material. The second and third expandable devices 730, located between the femur 126 and tibia 214, may be formed of a non-biodegradable material. Alternatively, the expandable devices 730 may all be formed of the same biodegradable material as the expandable devices 720 and 722.
It is contemplated that the expandable devices 720, 722 and/or 730 of
The manner in which the expandable devices 720, 722 and 730 may be utilized in association with any one of many joints in the patient's body is similar to that disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/526,949 filed on Mar. 16, 2000. The manner in which an expandable device similar to the expandable devices 720, 722 and 730 may be placed within a shoulder joint is similar to the disclosure in the aforementioned application Ser. No. 09/526,949 of which this application is a continuation in-part. The expandable devices 720, 722 and 730 may be utilized during carpal tunnel surgery in the manner disclosed in the aforementioned application Ser. No. 09/526,949. It is believed that it will be particularly advantageous to make the expandable devices 720, 722 and 730 of biodegradable material so that they may be left in a patient's body at the end of the surgery.
As previously mentioned, the expandable devices 720, 722 and 730 may be utilized during therapy after surgery to stretch body tissue in the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70 and/or to increase the range of motion of the knee portion. It is contemplated that an orthosis may be utilized to stretch tissue that limits joint movement. The orthosis may have a construction similar to the construction disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,611,764. The orthosis may be utilized to affect static progressive stretching of tissue in the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70. In addition, the orthosis may be utilized during progressive stress reduction. The orthosis may be utilized in conjunction with one or more expandable devices corresponding to the expandable devices 720, 722 and 730 in the patient's knee portion. Alternatively, the orthosis may be utilized without providing expandable devices in the patient's knee portion.
It is contemplated that, during restoration of the range of motion of the knee portion 76, a constant passive motion device may be connected with the patient's leg. The constant passive motion device may include one or more load or force limiting devices similar to those disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,456,268. The constant passive motion device may have a construction similar to that illustrated in U.S. Pat. No. 5,285,773. Of course, the constant passive motion device may have a different construction if desired. It is contemplated that a pulsatile stocking may be utilized to reduce the possibility of blood clots while a constant passive motion machine is utilized to increase the range of motion of the knee portion of a patient's leg.
It is contemplated that a laminer spreader may be used in association with the knee portion 76 during ligament balancing and/or gap balancing with the implants 286, 290 and 294. Alternatively, a distraction device which is spring loaded may be utilized on a medial, lateral or both sides of the knee portion 56 rather than the expandable elements 720, 722 and 730 to increase range of motion and/or provide a desired ligament balancing. Insol's technique may be utilized in establishing a desire range of motion of the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70.
Surgical Procedure
In the foregoing description of a specific surgical procedure which may be utilized in association with a knee portion 76 of a patient's leg, the femoral and tibial cuts are made, the patella is repaired and implants are installed in the knee portion 76 of the leg 70. However, it is contemplated that the various steps in this surgical operation may be performed in a different order if desired.
Immediately after the limited incision 114 (
After the patellar cut has been made, in the manner previously explained and before installation of the patellar implant, the tibial cut is undertaken. During the tibial cut, the patient's leg 70 is in the position illustrated in
While the tibial cut is being made, the patella 120 is offset from its normal position with the flat cut surface, previously formed on the inner side of the patella, facing toward the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. Since the patellar cut has already been made, the patella 120 is relatively thin and provides minimal stretching of the skin 342 and other tissues in the knee portion 76 when the patella is in the offset position of
After the tibial cut has been made, the femoral cuts are made. Making of the femoral cuts after making of the tibial cut and after making of the patellar cut maximizes the space which is available for the making of the femoral cuts. During the making of the femoral cuts, the patient's leg 70 is in the position illustrated in
After the femoral cuts have been made, the tibial tray 286 is positioned on the distal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 in the manner illustrated schematically in
Once the tibial and femoral implants 286, 290 and 294 have been positioned, the patellar implant is mounted on the cut surface of the patella 120. The patellar implant is positioned on the cut surface of the patella 120 while the patella is in the medially offset position illustrated in
By making the patellar cut before making of the tibial cut and the femoral cuts, the available space for the tibial cut and femoral cuts is maximized. Maximization of the space for the tibial cut and femoral cuts and for the insertion of the femoral implant 290 and tibial implants 286 and 294 is maximized by mounting the patellar implant after the femoral and tibial implants have been mounted.
It should be understood that the foregoing procedure is performed with the patient's leg in the position illustrated in
Femoral Cutting Guide
A femoral cutting guide 750 (
The guide surfaces 762 for the guide slot 752 are skewed at an acute angle of forty-five degrees to a major side surface 766 of the femoral cutting guide 750. Similarly, the guide surfaces 764 are skewed at an angle of forty-five degrees to the major side surface 756 of the femoral cutting guide 750. The guide surfaces 762 extend perpendicular to the guide surfaces 764. The guide surface 762 guide a saw blade during the making of an anterior chamfer resection on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. Similarly, the guide surfaces 764 guide a saw blade during the making of a posterior chamfer cut on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126.
The femoral cutting guide 750 has an anterior guide surface 770 which guides movement of a saw blade during the making of an anterior resection on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. Anterior guide surface 770 extends across the femoral cutting guide 750 between the lateral end portion 774 and a medial end portion 776 of the femoral cutting guide 750. The anterior guide surface 750 extends perpendicular to the major side surface 766 of the femoral cutting guide 750.
A posterior guide surface 780 guides movement of a saw blade during the making of a posterior resection on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. The posterior guide surface 780 extends between the lateral end portion 774 and the medial end portion 776 of the femoral cutting guide 770. The posterior guide surface 780 extends perpendicular to the major side surface 766 and extends parallel to the anterior guide surface 770. The anterior guide surface 770 and the posterior guide surface 780 extend transverse to the guide surfaces 762 and 764 of the guide slots 752 and 754.
The femoral cutting guide 750 is disposed on the distal end of the femur 126. The femoral cutting guide 750 is connected with the distal end of the femur 126 by a pair of pins 784 and 786. The pins 784 and 786 have longitudinal central axes which extend perpendicular to the major side surface 766 of the femoral cutting guide 750 and extend generally parallel to a longitudinal central axis of the femur 126.
When the femoral cuts are to be made on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126, the femoral cutting guide 750 is connected to the distal end of the femur. Initial portions of the various femoral cuts are then made by moving the saw blade along the guide surfaces 762, 764, 770 and 780 on the femoral cutting guide 750. Since the femoral cutting guide 750 extends only part way across the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126, the femoral cutting guide is disconnected from the femur and the femoral cuts are completed.
After the femoral cutting guide 750 has been disconnected from the femur 126, cut surfaces during formation of the initial portion of the anterior femoral cut are utilized to guide the saw blade during completion of the anterior femoral cut. Similarly, cut surfaces formed during the initial portion of the posterior femoral cut are utilized to guide the saw blade during completion of the posterior femoral cut. Cut surfaces formed during the making of anterior chamfer cut are utilized to guide the saw blade during completion of the anterior chamfer cut. Similarly, cut surfaces formed during making of the initial portion of the posterior chamfer cut are utilized to guide the saw blade during completion of the posterior chamfer cut.
The cutting tool which is used to form the femoral cuts, tibial cuts, and patellar cut may have any desired construction. Although a saw 172 and blade 170 have been disclosed herein as making the various cuts, many known types of cutting tools may be used if desired. For example, laser cutters, milling cutters, and/or ultrasonic cutters may be utilized. When one or more features of the present invention are utilized to perform knee joint revisions, an ultrasonic cutter may advantageously be utilized to cut cement previously used in association with an implant.
Side Cutting Guide
Using the femoral cutting guide 210 of
A femoral cutting guide 800 is illustrated in
The femoral cutting guide 800 has a distal guide surface 806. The distal guide surface 806 is disposed in a plane which extends perpendicular to a longitudinal central axis of the femur 126 and extends through the lateral and medial condyles. The distal guide surface 806 extends perpendicular to a major side surface 808 of the femoral cutting guide 800.
An anterior chamfer guide surface 812 extends between opposite major sides of the femoral cutting guide 800. The anterior chamfer guide surface 812 is disposed in a plane which extends at an acute angle of forty five degrees to a plane containing the distal guide surface 806. The anterior chamfer guide surface 812 extends perpendicular to the major side surface 808 of the femoral cutting guide 800. Similarly, a posterior chamfer guide surface 816 extends between opposite major sides of the femoral cutting guide 800. The posterior chamfer guide surface 816 is disposed in a plane which extends at an acute angle of forty five degrees to a plane containing the distal guide surface 806. The plane containing the posterior chamfer guide surface 816 extends perpendicular to the plane containing the anterior chamfer guide surface 812.
An anterior guide surface 820 is disposed on the femoral cutting guide 800. The anterior guide surface 820 extends between opposite major sides of the femoral cutting guide 800. The anterior guide surface 820 is disposed in a plane which extends perpendicular to a plane containing the distal guide surface 806. The plane containing the anterior guide surface 820 extends generally parallel to a longitudinal central axis of the femur 126.
Similarly, the femoral cutting guide 800 includes a posterior guide surface 824. The posterior guide surface 824 extends between opposite major sides of the femoral cutting guide 800. The posterior guide surface 824 is disposed in a plane which extends parallel to a plane containing the anterior guide surface 820 and perpendicular to a plane containing the distal guide surface 806.
The femoral guide 800 is formed of one piece of metal and has parallel opposite major side surfaces 808. The femoral cutting guide 800 is connected with the lateral side 802 of the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 by a pair of pins 830 and 832. The lateral side 802 of the femur may be cut to form a flat surface which is abuttingly engaged by a major side surface of the femoral cutting guide 800.
When the femoral cuts are to be made, the lateral side of the femur is cut to form a flat side surface on which the femoral cutting guide 800 is mounted by the pins 830 and 832. A saw blade or other cutting tool is then moved from the lateral side to the medial side of the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 while the saw blade or other cutting tool is guided by the distal guide surface 806 on the femoral cutting guide 800. The distal guide surface 806 has an extent which is less than the extent of the distal end cut to be formed on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. Therefore, after an initial portion of the distal end cut has been made utilizing the guide surface 806 to guide movement of a saw blade or other cutting tool, the cut surfaces are utilized to guide movement of the cutting tool during completion of the distal end cut.
Once the distal end cut has been completed, the saw blade or other cutting tool is moved from the lateral side of the femur 126 to the medial side of the femur along the anterior chamfer guide surface 812. The cutting tool is then moved from the lateral side of the femur 126 to the medial side of the femur along the posterior chamfer guide surface 816. Since the anterior chamfer guide surface 812 and posterior chamfer guide surface 816 have lengths which are less than the length of the anterior chamfer cut and posterior chamfer cut, only the initial portions of the chamfer cuts are made utilizing the guide surfaces 812 and 816 on the femoral cutting guide 800. The cuts are completed by guiding movement of the saw blade or other cutting tool with the previously cut surfaces.
The anterior guide surface 820 is then utilized to guide movement of the saw blade during an initial portion of an anterior cut. During making of the anterior cut, the saw blade or other cutting tool is moved from the lateral side to the medial side of the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. Since the anterior guide surface 820 is smaller than the anterior cut, surfaces formed during making of an initial portion of the anterior cut are utilized to guide the saw blade or other cutting tool during a final portion of the anterior cut.
Similarly, the posterior guide surface 824 on the femoral cutting guide 800 is utilized to guide the saw blade or other cutting tool during making of a posterior cut. During the making of an initial portion of the posterior cut, the saw blade is moved along the posterior guide surface 824 from the lateral side 802 of the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 to the medial side. The posterior guide surface 824 is shorter than the posterior cut. Therefore, cut surfaces formed during an initial portion of the posterior cut are utilized to guide the saw blade during completion of the posterior cut.
The femoral cutting guide 800 remains connected with the femur 126 during the initial portion of each of the femoral cuts and during completion of the femoral cuts. The femoral cutting guide 800 is not of the capture type. Therefore, a saw blade is free to move past the guide surfaces 806, 812, 816, 820 and 824 during completion of the femoral cuts. If the guide surfaces 806, 812, 816, 820 and 824 were formed by slots, the femoral cutting guide 800 would have to be disconnected from the femur before the femoral cuts could be completed.
The femoral cutting guide 800 has been illustrated in
During use of the femoral cutting guide 800, the patient's leg 70 can be in the orientation illustrated in
Optical Systems
Rather than using the guide members illustrated in
Utilizing pre-operative templating based on images of one or more bones in a patient's body, for example, a distal end portion 124 (
Although a hologram may be used to produce the three dimensional image 850 which is visible to the surgeon 106, the image may be created in other ways if desired. When the visible image 850 is to be projected onto a flat surface cut on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126, a two dimensional image may be utilized if desired. The two dimensional image 850 may be accurately projected on to the flat surface on the end portion 124 of thee femur 126 utilizing either coherent or non-coherent light and known image projection techniques.
The three dimensional image 850 has visible light beams 852 and 854 which define opposite ends of a sight line for guidance of a saw 172 or other cutting tool. If desired, light may be projected with a plane of colored light which extends between the light beams 852 and 854. The colored light plane extending between the light beams 852 and 854 is visible and provides a guide for alignment of a blade 170 in a desired spatial orientation relative to the side surface 802 on the femur 126.
The surgeon 106 moves the saw blade 170 along the colored plane of light extending between the light beams 852 and 854. The colored plane of light extending between the light beams 852 and 854 indicates to the surgeon the desired spatial orientation of the saw blade 170 during the making of a cut. A sensor connected with the saw 172 enables a computer connected with a source 858 of the image 850 to have the plane of light extend along each of the desired saw cuts during the making of the saw cut. Thus, during the making of the femoral cut which extends between the light beams 852 and 854, a plane of colored light extends between the light beams. This enables the surgeon to determine when the saw blade is properly aligned with the side surface 802 of the femur 126. When a different cut is to be made, for example, a cut between the light beam 852 and a light beam 862, a plane of colored light extends between the light beams 852 and 862. The plane of light is visible and indicates to the surgeon the desired spatial orientation of the blade 170 of the saw 172 relative to the femur 126.
In addition, locating laser light beams 866 and 868 are projected from laser light sources 872 and 874 mounted on the saw 172. The locating laser light beams 866 and 868 are visible to the surgeon 106 and are of a different color than the plane of light extending between the light beams 852 and 854 of the image 850. Therefore, a surgeon can visually determine when the locating laser light beams 866 and 868 are aligned with the plane of light extending between the light beams 852 and 854 of the image 850.
When the locating laser light beams 866 and 868 are disposed in the plane of light extending between the light beams 852 and 854, the saw blade 170 is accurately aligned with the portion of the femoral cut to be made between the light beams 852 and 854 of the image 850. If the locating laser light beams 866 and 868 are not disposed in the plane of light extending the light beams 852 and 854, the saw blade 170 is not in alignment with the desired location for the femoral cut.
In addition to the visual indication provided by alignment of the locating laser light beams 866 and 868 with the plane of light between the light beams 852 and 854, audible and/or visual signals may be provided to the surgeon indicating whether or not the locating laser light beams 866 and 868 are in alignment with the plane of colored light extending between the light beams 852 and 854. For example, a green light may be illuminated when the locating laser light beams 866 and 868 are in the same plane as the light beams 852 and 854 of the image 850. A red light may be illuminated when either or both of the locating laser light beams 866 and 868 are not located in the plane of colored light extending between the light beam 852 and the light beam 854. In addition, a warning sound, that is, an alarm, may be sounded when either one of the locating laser light beams 866 or 868 is offset from the plane of colored light extending between the light beams 852 and 854.
Once the femoral cut extending between the light beams 852 and 854 has been completed, the saw 172 and saw blade 170 are moved into alignment with a plane of colored light extending between the light beam 852 and 862. A second femoral cut is then made in the same manner as previously described in conjunction with the light beams 852 and 854. This process is repeated until the desired number of femoral cuts have been made.
In the embodiment illustrated in
As was previously mentioned, the three dimensional image 850 may be an image of anyone of the guides 138, 186, 210, 500, 750 or 800. The saw blade 170 would be moved along the image of a guide surface on the three dimensional image of the guide. The locating laser light beams 866 and 868 would indicate to the surgeon the orientation of the saw blade 170 relative to the three dimensional image of a guide surface on the three dimensional image of any one of the guides 138, 186, 210, 218, 500, 750 or 800. This would eliminate the heavy metal guides which have previously been used. When the size of any one of the three dimensional images of one of the guides 138, 186, 210, 218, 500, 750 or 800 is to be changed, it is merely necessary to have a computer controlling the projection of the three dimensional image to change a hologram being used to project the image or to effect a change in optics through which the image is projected.
Once the femoral cuts have been completed, an optical measuring device, such as an interferometer, may scan the cuts to determine if they have the desired configuration. Scanning the cuts with an optical measuring device may be used to eliminate the necessity of performing trials with provisional components. Eliminating the necessity of utilizing provisional components substantially reduces the amount of equipment required during a partial or total knee replacement.
The cut surfaces on the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 are illustrated in
The optical measuring device may have any one of many known constructions. For example, the optical measuring device may have the construction illustrated in U.S. Pat. No. 6,185,315 or 6,195,168 if desired. If an optical measuring device or other measuring device indicates that the cut surfaces are incorrect, a computer connected with the source 858 (
It is contemplated that the projector 858 could have any desired construction. For example, the projector 858 could have a construction which is generally similar to the construction of apparatus disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 6,211,976. It is contemplated that the laser light sources 872 and 874 could have a construction similar to the construction of devices disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,425,355. The laser light sources 872 and 874 may have a construction which is similar to the construction of devices which are commercially available from Laserscope, Inc. of San Jose, Calif.
It is contemplated that the patient's leg 70 will be in the position illustrated in
It is contemplated that the three dimensional image 850 may be used with procedures other than cutting of one or more bones in a patient's leg 70. For example, a three dimensional image of cuts to be made on a vertebra in a patient's back may be projected onto the vertebra. The three dimensional image may be used in surgery involving soft tissue in a patient's body. For example, the three dimensional image may be projected to a location in a patient's body where a vascular anastomosis or an intestinal anastomosis is to be undertaken. The three dimensional image may correspond to a pattern of stitches to be made between portions of soft body tissue. By projecting the three dimensional image into a patient's body at any desired location where surgery of any type is to be undertaken, a guide is provided in the patient's body to assist the surgeon.
The locating laser light beams 852 and 854 may be used with surgical instruments other than the saw 172. For example, the locating laser light beams 852 and/or 854 could be utilized to indicate the position of a bovie, or a needle, or forceps relative to body tissue. The locating laser light beams may have an intensity which is sufficient to shine through body tissue and enable a surgeon on one side of body tissue to visually determine the position of a surgical instrument on the opposite side of the body tissue.
Unicompartmental Knee Replacement
The drawings associated with the foregoing description have illustrated a full knee replacement rather than a partial knee replacement. However, it is contemplated that the previously described features of the present invention may be utilized with either a partial knee replacement or a full knee replacement. A femur 126 is illustrated schematically in
The saw 172 is provided with laser light sources 902 and 904. The laser light sources 902 and 904 project visible locating laser light beams 906 and 908 which extend along opposite longitudinal edges of the saw blade 170. The locating laser light beams 906 and 908 impinge against the condyle 892. The locating light beams are of colored coherent light which is visible to a surgeon to indicate the orientation of the saw blade 170 relative to the condyle 892.
It is contemplated that the saw 172 and blade 170 may be utilized in association with a guide member which is connected with the femur 126. Alternatively, a two or three dimensional image, corresponding to the image 850 of
Rather than using a saw blade 170 to make the cut in the condyle 892, it should be understood that a different type of cutting tool could be utilized if desired. For example, a milling cutter could be used to cut along a line 896 in
Multiple Incisions
A single incision 114 is illustrated in
After the femoral cuts have been made through the small incision 920 and the larger or main incision 114, femoral and/or tibial implants are moved through the main incision. By providing the small incision 920 in association with the larger main incision 114, the overall length of the main incision may be minimized.
During making of the incisions 114 and 970, the patient's leg 70 is in the position illustrated in
In the embodiment of the invention illustrated in
By using more than one incision, that is, the main incision 114 and one or more small incisions 920, cutting tools can approach and move along the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 from different directions. Thus, the saw blade 170 moves from the right to the left as viewed in
Although it is preferred to make the incisions 114 and 920 and to cut the femur 126 with the leg 70 of the patient in the position illustrated in
Patellar Tracking
A pair of transducers 596 and 598 are illustrated in
In accordance with another feature of the invention, a pair of patellar transducers 930 and 932 are disposed on an inner side of the patella 120. The patellar transducers 930 and 932 are connected with a display, corresponding to the computer display areas 601 and 602 of
The patellar transducers 930 and 932 have outputs which correspond to force transmitted between the patella 120 and the femur 126. Thus, the output from the transducer 930 corresponds to the force transmitted between the lateral side of the patella 120 and a lateral side of a trochlear groove in the femur 126. Similarly, the output from the transducer 932 corresponds to the force transmitted between a medial side of the patella 120 and a medial side of the trochlear groove in the femur 126. By comparing the output from the patellar transducers 930 and 932 during relative movement between the femur 126 and tibia 214, variations in the force transmitted between the lateral and medial portions of the patella 120 can be compared. This enables a surgeon to determine when the patella is tracking properly relative to the femur 126.
The patellar transducers 930 and 932 are resiliently expandable containers which hold fluid. As the force transmitted between the patella 120 and the femur 126 increases, the pressure of the fluid in the patellar transducers 930 and 932 increases. It is contemplated that the containers 930 and 932 may hold either a gas or a liquid. Pressure signals corresponding to the pressure in the patellar transducers 930 and 932 are conducted through conductors 934 and 936 to a display, corresponding to the computer displays 601 and 602 of
During checking of patellar tracking with the transducers 930 and 932, the upper portion 72 of the leg 70 of the patient is supported above the support surface 64 by the leg holder 80 (
The patellar transducers 930 and 932 are mounted on the patella 120 after the patellar implant has been mounted on the patella. This enables the patellar transducers 930 and 932 to be utilized to detect any irregularities in the manner in which the patellar implant cooperates with the femoral implant 290 (
In the embodiment of
The transducers 596 and 598 can be utilized in combination with the patellar transducers 930 and 932 (
When it is determined that the patella 120 is not tracking properly, corrective action may be taken by increasing the fluid pressure in either or both of the patellar transducers 930 and 932. If the transducers 596 and 598 are utilized, the corrective action may include increasing the fluid pressure in either or both of the transducers 596 and 598. The transducers 596 and 598 and the patella transducers 930 and 932 are formed of resilient material which can be expanded under the influence of fluid pressure.
Although the patellar transducers 930 and 932 are utilized to measure force transmitted between lateral and medial portions of the patella 120 and the femur 126, the patellar transducers can be utilized to stretch or move body tissue in the same manner as the expandable devices 720, 722 and 730 (
The patellar transducers 930 and 932 may be formed of either a biodegradable material or a non-biodegradable material. When the patellar transducers 930 and 932 are to be left in the knee portion 76, the patellar transducers may be formed of a biodegradable material which is eventually absorbed by the patient's body. When the patellar transducers 930 and 932 are to be removed from the knee portion 76, the patella transducers may be formed of a non biodegradable material. If the patellar transducers 930 and 932 are formed of a biodegradable material and are left in the knee portion 76 after closing of the incision 114, the patellar transducers may be expanded during therapy to stretch body tissue connected with the patella 120.
Movable Implant
The implant 690 of
The moveable implant 950 has a smooth upper (as viewed in
During bending of the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70, the implant 950 may move relative to both the femur 126 and the tibia 214. The implant 950 can move in either a lateral or medial direction relative to the femur 126 and tibia 214. In addition, the implant 950 can move in either a posterior or anterior direction relative to the femur 126 and tibia 214.
By having a three hundred and sixty degree (360°) range of movement relative to both the femur 126 and tibia 214, the moveable implant 950 accommodates relative movement between the femur and tibia with minimal pain. This is because relative movement will occur between the implant 950, femur 126 and tibia 214 at locations where frictional forces due to irregularities on the surfaces of the femur 126 and tibia 214 are minimal. In addition, the implant 950 can shift relative to the femur 126 and tibia 214 during bending of the knee portion 76 to accommodate irregularities in the existing surfaces 958 and 960 on the distal end portion 124 of the femur and the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia.
The range of movement of the implant 950 relative to the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 is limited by engagement of the moveable implant 950 with soft tissue in the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70. Therefore, even though the implant 950 can move relative to the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126 and the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214, the implant is held against excessive movement relative to the femur and tibia by soft tissues associated with the femur and tibia.
For example, engagement of the implant 950 with cartilage or other soft tissue which is located at the peripheral aspect of the knee joint between the femur 126 and tibia 214 retains the implant 950 within a desired range of movement. The cartilage may be articular cartilage and/or fibrocartilage. The cartilage is engaged by peripheral surfaces on the moveable implant 952 and retains the implant in a desired position relative to the femur 126 and tibia 214. In addition, fibrous connective tissue extending between the femur 126 and tibia 214 limits movement of the implant 950 relative to the femur and tibia.
The joint capsule in the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg may be engaged by the periphery of the implant 950 to retain the implant in a desired position. By using cartilaginous, ligamentous, or other tissues to limit the range of movement of the moveable implant 950, the implant can freely shift relative to the femur 126 and tibia 214 through a limited range of movement during bending of the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70. If desired, growth of the tissues used to limit the range of movement of the implant may be promoted.
The moveable implant 950 is sized so as to fit the surfaces 958 and 960 on the distal end portion 124 and proximal end portion 212 of the femur 126 and tibia 214 (
Thus, for a relatively large individual, a moveable implant 950 having a relatively large size is selected from the series of moveable implants. Similarly, for an individual having a relatively small size, a moveable implant 950 having a relatively small size is selected from the series of moveable implants. The selected implant has a size which corresponds to the general size of the space between the surfaces 958 and 960.
As a result of imaging of the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70, the actual configurations of the existing surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214 can be accommodated by shaping the upper surface 952 of the moveable implant 958 to have a configuration corresponding to the surface 958 on the femur 126. Similarly, the lower surface 954 on the moveable implant 950 can be shaped to have a configuration corresponding to the configuration of the surface 960 on the tibia 214. Of course, the configuration of the periphery of the moveable implant can be changed to correspond to the configuration of the periphery of the space between the surfaces 958 and 960 into which the moveable implant 950 is to be placed.
It is contemplated that the imaging of the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70 may be done preoperatively, on an out-patient basis. The moveable implant 950 may then be selected from the series of available moveable implants and shaped to have a configuration which corresponds to the configuration of the space between the surfaces 958 and 960. The implant 950, which has been shaped to conform to the space between the surfaces 958 and 960, may then be moved to an operating room for insertion into a patient during the surgical procedure. Alternatively, the imaging of the knee portion 76 and shaping of the moveable implant 950 to the desired configuration may be performed in the operating room as part of the surgical procedure.
When the moveable implant 950 is to be positioned in the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70, in the manner indicated schematically in
The incision may have a limited length, corresponding to the limited length of the incision 114 of
Once the limited incision 114 has been formed in the manner previously described in conjunction with
Once this has been done, the surgeon may or may not decide to cut tissue in the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70 before inserting the moveable implant 950. If the surgeon elects to cut tissue in the knee portion 76 before insertion of the implant, this cutting will be relatively minor and will not involve the femoral and tibial cuts depicted in
Once the moveable implant 950 has been positioned between the existing surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214, the patella 120 is moved from the offset position of
Any known imaging apparatus may utilized to image the knee portion 76 of the patient's leg 70. For example, the known C-arm fluoroscope 360 of
Rather than forming the incision 114 in the manner illustrated schematically in
The cannula 564 (
The moveable implant 950 is flexible so that force transmitted between the femur 126 and tibia 214 deflects the moveable implant 950. This results in the moveable implant 950 being shaped by the surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214. By shaping the upper surface 952 on the moveable implant 950 with the surface 958 on the femur 126, smooth sliding engagement is provided between the surface 958 on the femur 126 and the upper surface 952 on the moveable implant 950. Similarly, the lower surface 954 on the implant 950 is shaped by the surface 960 on the tibia 214. By shaping the lower surface 954 on the implant 950 with the surface 960 on the tibia 214, smooth sliding engagement is provided between the surface 960 on the tibia 214 and the lower surface 954 on the moveable implant 950 during bending of the knee portion 76.
Shaping of the surfaces 952 and 954 on the moveable implant 950 may be accomplished in any one of many different ways. For example, the implant 950 may be formed of a material which is resiliently deflected by the surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214. This results in the upper surface 952 and lower surface 954 and the moveable implant 950 being resiliently deflected to have a configuration corresponding to the configuration of the portions of the surfaces 958 and 960 which are engaged by the moveable implant during bending of the knee portion 76. During bending of the knee portion 76, the moveable implant 950 shifts or moves relative to the surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214. During this shifting movement, the configuration of the upper surface 952 and the lower surface 954 of the moveable implant 950 is resiliently changed by forces transmitted between the femur 126 and tibia 214 through the moveable implant 950.
Rather than having the moveable implant 950 resiliently deflected by force transmitted between the femur 126 and tibia 214, the moveable implant 950 may be plastically deformed by the force transmitted between the femur and the tibia. Thus, the surface 958 on the femur 126 may plastically deform the upper surface 952 on the moveable implant 950 so that it retains a configuration corresponding to the configuration of the surface 958 on the femur 126. Similarly, the surface 960 on the tibia 214 may be plastically deform the lower surface 954 on the moveable implant 950 so that it maintains a configuration corresponding to the configuration of the surface 960 on the tibia 214. By plastically deforming the material of the moveable implant 950 with the surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214, smooth sliding engagement is obtained between the upper and lower surfaces 952 and 954 on the moveable implant 950 during bending of the knee portion 76.
Even though the upper and lower surfaces 952 and 954 on the moveable implant 950 are either elastically or plastically shaped by the force transmitted between the femur 126 or tibia 214, the moveable implant will, initially, be configured to have a shape corresponding to the existing space between the surfaces 958 and 960. It is contemplated that this will result in the surfaces 952 and 954 being spaced apart by different distances between different portions of the moveable implant 950.
For example, the distance between the upper surface 952 and lower surface 954 on the moveable implant 950 may be relatively large adjacent to a medial edge portion of the moveable implant 950. The distance between the upper and lower surfaces 952 and 954 on the moveable implant 950 may be relatively small adjacent to a lateral edge portion of the moveable implant. As was previously mentioned, it is contemplated that images be generated of the knee portion 76 to enable the shape of the existing space between the surfaces 958 and 960 to be determined and to enable the moveable implant 950 to be configured, outside of the patient's body, to a configuration which generally conforms to the configuration of the space between the surfaces 958 and 960. Once the moveable implant 950 has been initially shaped to a configuration corresponding to the configuration of the space between the surfaces 958 and 960, the implant is positioned between the surfaces.
It is contemplated that the moveable implant 950 may be relatively thin compared to the thickness of the moveable implant illustrated schematically in
It is contemplated that a relatively flexible moveable implant 950 may be configured so as to readily fit into an existing space in the knee portion 76. This would result in a tendency for the moveable implant 950 to become seated on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. The moveable implant 950 would be seated on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 by force applied against the moveable implant by the surface 958 on the femur 126. The lower surface of the moveable implant would be permanently deflected to have a configuration corresponding to the configuration of the upper surface 960 in the tibia 214. The upper surface 952 of the moveable implant would have an overall configuration which may differ from the configuration of the surface 958 on the femur 126. However, even though the configuration of the upper surface 952 on the moveable implant 950 is different than the configuration on the surface 958 on the femur 126, there would be smooth sliding engagement between the surface 958 on the femur 126 and the upper surface 952 of the moveable implant 950. The result would be that there would be relatively little movement between the lower surface 954 of the moveable implant 950 and the surface 960 on the tibia 214 during bending of the knee portion 76. However, there would be a relatively large amount of movement between the upper surface 952 of the implant 950 and the surface 958 on the femur 126. Since the moveable implant 950 would be permanently deflected to have a configuration corresponding to the space between the existing surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214, the existing surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214 would cooperate with the moveable implant 950 without inducing pain in the knee portion 76 of the leg 70 of the patient.
It is contemplated that the moveable implant 950 may be formed of many different materials. For example, the moveable implant 950 may be formed of a biological material. For example, the moveable implant 950 may be formed of allograft or autograft or xenograft. Combinations of these graft materials may be utilized. These graft materials may be shaped in the manner disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,888,219. The moveable implant 950 may be formed of the same materials as the implant 626 of
It is believed that it may be desired to form the moveable implant 950 of metal. For example, the moveable implant 950 could be formed of chromium, titanium, tantalum, zirconium or aluminum. The metal forming a moveable implant may or may not have a porous construction. The metal forming the moveable implant 950 would have a wettable surface which can be wetted by body fluids to provide lubricity. If the moveable implant 950 is formed of a porous metal, the metal may be impregnated with one or more polymeric materials which function as lubricants.
The moveable implant 950 may be formed of a ceramic material. The ceramic material of the moveable implant may have either a porous or non-porous construction. When the ceramic material of the moveable implant 950 has a porous construction, it is contemplated that the openings in the ceramic material will be filled with a lubricant to facilitate relative movement between the surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214 and the surfaces 952 and 954 on the moveable implant 950.
When the moveable implant 950 is formed of a porous material, for example a porous metal or a porous ceramic, it is contemplated that the moveable implant could be impregnated with both a bone growth promoting material and a lubricant. For example, the portion of the porous moveable implant 950 adjacent to the upper surface 952 of the implant may be impregnated with a lubricant. The portion of the moveable implant 950 adjacent to the lower surface 954 may be impregnated with bone growth inductive materials.
With such a construction, the lower surface 954 of the moveable implant is configured to correspond to the configuration of the surface 960 on the tibia 214. Therefore, the moveable implant will tend to become seated on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. Once this has occurred, the bone growth promoting materials in the porous implant 950, adjacent to the lower surface 954 of the implant, will promote growth of bone into the moveable implant 950 to connect the moveable implant with the tibia 214. The lubricant in the porous material adjacent to the upper surface 952 of the moveable implant 950 will minimize friction with the surface 958 on the femur 126 so that there will be minimal tendencies for the moveable implant 950 to move relative to the tibia 214 once the moveable implant has become seated on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia. Of course, this will facilitate the growth of bone between the surface 960 on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 and the moveable implant 950.
The moveable implant 950 may be formed of graft materials which have been shaped in the manner disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,888,219. If desired, the moveable implant 950 may have a three dimensional scaffold or framework structure on which graft materials are disposed. The framework on which the graft materials are disposed may have sufficient flexibility to enable the moveable implant 950 to be flexed to correspond to the configuration of the surface 960 on the tibia 214 by force applied against the upper surface 952 of the moveable implant by the femur 126. The graft materials on the scaffold will be shaped by the surface 958 on the femur 126 to form the upper surface 952 of the implant with the configuration which corresponds to the configuration of the surface 958 on the femur.
It is contemplated that the moveable implant 950 may be formed of materials which degrade with the passage of time. Thus, after the implant 950 has been disposed in the knee portion 76 of a patient's leg 70 for a predetermined period of time, for example two years, it may be necessary to replace the moveable implant 950. Due to the limited incision required to enable the implant 950 to be positioned in the knee portion 76, it is a relatively simple operation to replace the moveable implant 950. The size of the incision and the trauma induced in the patient by replacing the moveable implant 950 may be minimized by the use of a cannula corresponding to the cannula 564 of
Seating of the moveable implant on the tibia 214 may be promoted by forming the moveable implant of a hydrophilic material which absorbs body fluids and expands. When the implant 950 of hydrophilic material is positioned in the space between the surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214, the hydrophilic material of the implant will absorb body fluids and expand to fully occupy the space. This will result in the lower surface 954 of the moveable implant 950 being pressed firmly against the surface 960 on the tibia 214. Similarly, the upper surface 952 on the moveable implant 950 will be pressed against the surface 958 on the femur 126 as the moveable implant absorbs body fluids and expands. This results in the moveable implant 950 expanding in such a manner as to change the configuration of the moveable implant to the configuration of the space between the surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214.
The hydrophilic material of the moveable implant 950 may be a polymeric material which is either a copolymer or a dipolymer. The hydrophilic material may contain petroylglupamic acid, carboxymethylcellulose, a collagen or polylactide. The hydrophilic material may be a ceramic that is found in hydroxyapatite composites with polyethylene, polylactide or polyhydroxybutyrate. Of course, the moveable implant 950 could be formed of other known hydrophilic materials which attract body liquid under the influence of molecular attraction and establishes molecular linkages with the body liquid. The hydrophilic material may be disposed on a frame work or base which is formed of a non hydrophilic material such as a porous metal.
It should be understood that the patient's leg 70 is supported in a manner previously explained herein in conjunction with
Moveable Inlay
In the embodiment of
The moveable implant 970 may be held in position relative to the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 by engagement with the recess 972. If this is done, tissue growth promoting materials and/or materials which promote biological resurfacing may be provided in the moveable implant 970. These materials would promote the growth of tissue adjacent to the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 into the moveable implant 970. The biological resurfacing materials would promote the growth of naturally occurring tissues, which were not removed to form the recess 972, into the moveable implant 970. Thus, cartilage tissues located adjacent to the peripheral aspect of the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214 would grow into the moveable implant 970.
It should be understood that the recess 972 may have a lower surface formed by the existing surface 960 of the tibia and side surfaces formed by fibrocartilage which extends around the periphery of the moveable implant 970. It is believed that it will be desired to position the moveable implant 970 in the recess 972 without anchoring the moveable implant to the tibia 214. However, if desired, an adhesive such as fibrin could be utilized to connect the moveable implant with the existing surface 960 on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia. The moveable implant 970 may have any one of the constructions previously described in conjunction with the implant 640 of
Multi Component Moveable Implant
The moveable implant 950 of
The lower section 984 of the moveable implant 980 has a lower surface 994 which engages the existing surface 960 on the proximal end portion 212 of the tibia 214. In addition, the lower section 984 of the implant 980 has an upper surface 986 which engages a lower surface 990 on the upper section 982 of the moveable implant 980.
The surfaces on the moveable implant 980 which engage existing surfaces on the femur 126 or tibia 214 are shaped to conform to the configuration of the existing surfaces on the femur and the tibia. To enable the surfaces on the moveable implant to be shaped to conform to the configuration of existing surfaces on the femur 126 and tibia 214, images of the femur and tibia are generated utilizing known imaging apparatus, such as an MRI, X-ray, or fluoroscope. These images are utilized to determine the configuration of the existing surface 958 on the femur 126 and the existing surface 960 on the tibia 214. The upper surface 988 on the upper section 982 of the moveable implant 980 is then shaped to a configuration corresponding to the configuration of the existing surface 958 on the femur 156. The lower surface 994 on the lower section 984 of the moveable implant 980 is shaped to a configuration corresponding to the configuration of the existing surface 960 on the tibia 214. By shaping the upper and lower surfaces 988 and 994 on the implant 990 to conform to the shape of the existing surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214, the upper and lower sections 982 and 984 tend to seat themselves on the femur 126 and tibia 214. Thus, the upper surface 988 on the upper section 982 of the moveable implant 980 becomes seated against the existing surface 958 on the femur 126 under the influence of force transmitted between the existing surface 958 on the femur and the upper surface 988 on the upper section 982 of the moveable implant 980. Similarly, the lower surface 994 on the lower section 984 of the implant 980 becomes seated against the existing surface 960 on the tibia 214 under the influence of force applied to the upper surface 996 on the lower section 984 of the moveable implant 980 by the upper section 982 of the moveable implant.
The lower surface 990 on the upper section 982 of the moveable implant 980 and the upper surface 996 on the lower section 984 of the moveable implant 980 are shaped to promote the desired articulation in the knee portion 76 of the leg 70. Once the two sections 982 and 984 of the moveable implant 980 have been positioned between the existing surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214, relative movement occurs where the lower surface 990 on the upper section 982 of the moveable implant 980 engages the upper surface 996 on the lower section 984 of the moveable implant. This tends to minimize any pain or discomfort resulting from defects in the existing surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214 during bending of the knee portion 76.
The upper section 982 and lower section 984 may be formed of the same materials or any combination of the same materials as previously described in conjunction with the moveable implant 950 of
The moveable implant 980 will be positioned in the space between the existing surfaces 958 and 960 on the femur 126 and tibia 214 in the manner previously discussed in conjunction with the embodiment of the invention illustrated in
Moveable Implant with Anchored Section
In the embodiment of the invention illustrated in
The upper section 1006 and lower section 1008 of the moveable implant 1002 are formed of the same material as previously discussed in conjunction with the moveable implant 950. The upper and lower sections 1006 and 1008 of the moveable implant 1002 are positioned in the space between the existing surfaces 958 and 960 through a cannula which corresponds to the cannula 564 of
Although the lower section 1008 of the moveable implant 1002 has been illustrated in
Securing Moveable Anchor
In the embodiment of the invention illustrated in
The moveable implant 1020 has the same construction as the moveable implant 950 of
It is contemplated that the moveable implant 1020 will have a construction which promotes the in growth of tissue from the ligament 1022 into the implant. Thus, the moveable implant 1020 may have a porous scaffold on which tissue growth inductive factors are disposed. For example, the moveable implant 1020 could be formed of porous tantalum. The porous tantalum scaffold could contain collagen, fibrin, progenitor cells and/or tissue inductive factors. Of course, other known materials which promote biological resurfacing could be provided on the porous metal scaffold of the moveable implant 1020 if desired.
Although one specific construction of the moveable implant 1020 has been described, it is contemplated that the moveable implant 1020 could have many different constructions. For example, the moveable implant 1020 could have any one of the constructions and be formed of any one or more of the materials previously described in conjunction with the moveable implant 950.
It is contemplated that the patient's leg 70 may be in the position illustrated in
Connection of Moveable Implant with Soft Tissue
In the embodiment of the invention illustrated in
The moveable implant 1040 (
In accordance with one of the features of this embodiment of the invention, a plurality of connections 1044 are provided between the periphery of the moveable implant 1040 and soft tissue 1046. Although many different soft tissues in the knee portion 76 of a patient's leg may be connected with the moveable implant 1040 by connections 1044, in the embodiment of the invention illustrated in
By providing anterior and posterior connections 1044 with the soft tissue of the joint capsule 1046, the moveable implant 1040 is held against excessive movement in either a posterior or anterior direction. Similarly, the connections 1044 between the moveable implant 1040 and the medial portion of the soft tissue or joint capsule 1046 holds the moveable implant 1040 against excessive movement in either the medial or lateral direction. The connections 1040 may initially be formed by sutures.
Although the range of movement of the moveable implant 1040 relative to the femur 126 and tibia 214 (
Tissue inductive growth factors are provided on the moveable implant 1040. The tissue inductive growth factors promote a growth of the soft tissue onto the moveable implant 1040. It is contemplated that the moveable implant 1040 will have a porous platform in which the tissue growth inductive factors are disposed. This will promote a growth of the soft tissue or joint capsule 1046 into the moveable implant 1040 to assist the sutures at the connections 1044 in interconnecting the moveable implant 1040 and the soft tissue or joint capsule 1046.
Thus, the connections 1044 between the moveable implant 1040 and the soft tissue 1046 is initially established by sutures which extend between the moveable implant 1040 and the soft tissue or joint capsule 1046. With the passage of time, tissue grows from the soft tissue or joint capsule 1046 into the periphery of the moveable implant 1040 to further interconnect the moveable implant 1040 and the soft tissue. The sutures which initially form the connections 1044, hold the periphery of the moveable implant 1040 in engagement with the soft tissue 1046. Due to the intimate apposition of the moveable implant 1040 with the soft tissue or joint capsule 1046 and the tissue growth promoting factors in the moveable implant 1040, growth of the soft tissue or joint capsule 1046 into the periphery of the moveable implant 1040 is promoted.
Molded Implant
In the embodiment of the invention illustrated in
Once the bone cement has hardened, the retainer or dam 1064 may be removed. The bone cement then forms an implant which is disposed on the existing surface 960 of the tibia 214. The bone cement is connected with existing surface 960 of the tibia 214 by adhesion between the implant 1060 and the existing surface 960 of the tibia 214. It is contemplated that a releasing agent could be mixed with the bone cement which is used to form the implant 1060 so that the implant would not adhere to the existing surface 960 of the tibia 214. This would result in the implant 1060 being freely moveable relative to both the tibia 214 and the femur 126 in the same manner as in which the moveable implant 950 is freely moveable relative to the femur 126 and tibia 214.
Deformity Correction
The moveable implants of
The devices which compensate for bone deformities may have a construction similar to the construction of any one of the devices disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 6,086,593. Of course, other known devices could be utilized to correct bone deformities if desired.
One specific device which may be utilized to correct bone deformities is a wedge member 1080 (
When the wedge member 1080 is to be positioned in the tibia 214, a saw cut is made to form a slot at the location where the wedge member 1080 is to be installed. The saw cut and resulting slot extend only part way through the tibia 214. The wedge member 1080 is then moved into the slot. As the wedge member is forced into the slot, the wedge member pivots an upper portion of the tibia 214 in a counter-clockwise direction (as viewed in
Although the wedge member 1080 has been illustrated in
It is contemplated that the patient's leg 70 will be in the position illustrated in
The foregoing description of the moveable implants of
In-Situ Bone Removal
As previously detailed, one aspect of the present invention is the performance of all or a portion of a surgical procedure through a cannula.
A pilot hole can be created through femur 1102 to help insert guide wire 1108. Additionally, the creation of this pilot hole and/or the insertion of guide wire 1108 can be done under imaging guidance, such as fluoroscopy. Additionally, the proximal end of guide wire 1108 or cannula 1104 (
Cannula 1104 is advantageously expandable to further stretch the viscoelastic tissue. Of course, expanding cannula 1104 increases the size of a passage 1110 formed by an inner side 1112 of cannula 1104, thereby enabling a relatively large object to pass through the passage. Thus, cannula 1104 may be expanded to facilitate movement of surgical implements, such as implants and instruments through the cannula.
It is contemplated that expandable cannula 1104 may have many different known constructions. The illustrated cannula 1104 is formed of elastomeric material and has the same construction as disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 6,338,730. It should be understood that cannula 1104 could have a different construction, for example, a construction similar to the constructions disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 3,811,449 or 5,183,464.
Cannula 1104 can be expanded in many different ways other than under the influence of force transmitted directly to the cannula from an object moving through the cannula. Cannula 1104 may be expanded by inserting tubular members into the cannula. Alternatively, fluid pressure could be used to expand cannula 1104 in the manner disclosed in the aforementioned U.S. Pat. No. 6,338,730.
By utilizing expandable cannula 1104 or the expandable pneumatic retractors previously disclosed, force can be applied against opposite sides of incision 1106 to stretch the viscoelastic material disposed adjacent to opposite sides of the incision. This will result in the relatively small incision 1106 being expanded to accommodate relatively large surgical instruments and/or implants.
Once cannula 1104 is inserted, guide wire 1108 can be removed if desired. Alternatively, guide wire 1108 can be used to direct insertion of other surgical implements. Regardless of whether guide wire 1108 is removed, cannula 1104 can be moved or pivoted about incision 1106 so that its location can be varied. This is particularly useful, for example, if the area surrounding the surgical site needs to be accessed.
Although a single incision 1106 is illustrated in
If desired, tissue retractors and/or dissectors can be used to create space between the soft tissue and the bones of the hip joint. Prior art mechanical dissectors and retractors can be used. It is also contemplated that fluid operated retractors, expanders, and/or dissectors may be used to retract, expand or dissect body tissue. For example, retractors having a construction similar to any one of the constructions disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,197,971 may be utilized to release tissue at locations spaced from incision 1106. When tissue is to be released at locations where there is limited accessibility from incision 1106, a device similar to any one of the devices disclosed in U.S. Pat. No. 5,295,994 may be utilized. It is believed that devices similar to those disclosed in U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/526,949 filed Mar. 16, 2000 may be used in ways similar to those disclosed therein to move and/or release body tissue.
As shown in
In the case of a hip replacement surgery (total or partial), a reamer is typically used to create a uniform cavity for the acetabular component and/or an oscillating blade is typically used to remove a portion of the femoral head so that the femoral component can be received in the medullary canal of the femur. In this regard, compact cutting tools, similar to those utilized for arthroscopic, endoscopic, or fiber optic assisted surgery may be at least partially moved through passage 1110 to affect in situ removal of bone. The cutting tools may have a construction similar to the construction illustrated in U.S. Pat. No. 5,540,695 or 5,609,603. Alternatively, the cutting tools may have a construction similar to the construction disclosed in published U.S. Patent Application No. 2002/0055755 A1.
U.S. Pat. No. 5,269,785 also discloses a tissue removal system and method that can be used with the limited incision system according to the present invention. This patent discloses a device with a flexible shaft and a controllable tip. Furthermore, the device can be single lumen or multi-lumen, with a cannula if desired. The cutting tip can be controlled via valves, pneumatics, radio control, fiberoptic control, electric wire control, cable control, or pneumatic control. Multiple movable segments or a single movable segment can provide the flexibility. Joints can be provided between rigid sections. The flexibility and controllability are particularly useful in limited incision procedures. For example, the device can be bent over a 60-90° angle, and then selectively remove osteophytes at the edge of the tissue without damaging the associated tissue. Furthermore, the option of suction provides for tissue removal and the option of irrigation minimizes heat necrosis in the limited operative space.
The reaming of the acetabulum can be done in a single pass with a single reamer, or a plurality of progressively larger reamers can be used. Guide wire 1108 is particularly helpful with multiple reamers since the locking of guide wire 1108 with respect to acetabulum 1100 helps ensure that each reamer is reaming about the same central axis.
Convex top side 1132 of the cup-shaped distal end 1124 has at least one cutting surface 1134 (shown in the form of gratings typical of prior art acetabular reamers) so that rotation of instrument 1120 in conjunction with antegrade movement of instrument 1120, i.e. movement in the direction of arrow 1136 (
Activation of instrument 1120 can occur in a number of different ways. For example, rotational movement of instrument 1120 alone can cause instrument 1120 to go from the retracted (
After removal of the head of femur 1102 and reaming of acetabulum 1100, the cutting tool or tools can be withdrawn from the hip joint. In the case of instrument 1120, instrument 1120 can be pulled back through passage 1110, with distal end 1124 in the retracted position, or in the expanded position if the diameter of passage 1110 permits and the surgeon so desires. Alternatively, distal end 1124 can be separated from the rest of instrument 1120, for example by cutting off and removal through a separate incision.
It should be noted that the reaming of acetabulum 1100 and removal of the head of femur 1102 can be done with minimal, i.e. subluxation, or no dislocation of the hip joint. As previously noted, access to the joint space can be increased by movement of cannula 1104. Additionally, the joint space can be manipulated remotely. For example and as shown in
The present invention also envisions insertion of some or all of the implant components through cannula 1104. This concept will be illustrated with a description of the procedure for an acetabular component. An analogous procedure for the femoral component can be used and a procedure for use with the knee has been described above.
Guide wire 1108 can be removed so that a standard liner or insert (typically made of polyethylene) can be used in conjunction with backing 1140. Alternatively and as shown in
Other acetabular designs can be used. For example, the backing and liner acetabular components can be bonded together, either inside or outside of the patient. The portions may be bonded together by the application of energy in any one of many different forms, such as ultrasonic energy and heat. The present invention also envisions the application of the principles described and shown in
In knee replacement procedures, in situ reaming of the patella as well as the condyles of the femur and tibia can be performed. Specifically, a guide wire is placed over the condyles and reaming occurs over this guide wire using a mill or a cutting saw. The patella could be removed in a similar fashion with a retrograde reamer directed by a guide wire. As previously described, the milling/cutting tools could be used in conjunction with jigs that allow a plurality of intersecting straight cuts or a smooth arc cut. The jig can be mounted on the medial or lateral side. If desired, the cutting of the femur and tibia can be done using a limited incision approach and the implantation of the femur, tibia, and/or patella components can be done through a larger incision.
Lateral/Medial Approach to Knee Replacement
As previously discussed (see, e.g.
In this regard,
By accessing the joint space from a side medial or lateral to the centerline of the joint, the incision can be made shorter, as previously discussed. Additionally, and as previously discussed, a medial or lateral incision stretches less than a direct anterior incision. With respect to the knee joint in particular, when an incision is directly over the patella, the incision length increases 30% from 0° extension to 120° flexion. If the incision is shifted more laterally or medially, such as over the medial collateral ligament, the incision only lengthens approximately 12% from 0° extension to 120° flexion. There is less stress on the soft tissue and therefore less scarring and less postoperative pain. Also by going more medial or lateral with the incision there is less damage and less disruption of the quadriceps mechanism. Furthermore, patella 1168 tends to naturally move toward the pivot location when the joint space is hinged open from either a medial or lateral approach. The natural movement of patella 1168 allows anterior access to the joint space without the need to evert patella 1168. However, patella 1168 can be minimally subluxed and/or everted to increase the exposure of the joint space, if desired.
Returning to the embodiment in
In contrast, tibial tray 1170 is a modular unit comprising a base 1172 and a keel 1174. An inferior surface 1176 of tibial tray 1170 is substantially flat so that tibial tray 1170 can be slid into position from the lateral or medial side onto previously cut or milled tibia 1156. A side cutting jig analogous to that shown in
Base 1172 and keel 1174 can be provided with a locking mechanism to secure keel 1174 to base 1172. One example of such a mechanism is a locking screw 1181 that inserts through base 1172 and keel 1174. If keel 1174 is implanted after tibial tray 1170, keel 1174 can also be provided with a head 1182 or other stop mechanism that prevents further insertion of keel 1174 through openings 1178 once keel 1174 has been inserted through openings 1178 a given distance. In one embodiment, head 1182 can be made to be flush with superior surface 1180 of base 1172. In this regard, openings 1178 have a countersink 1184 for accommodating keel head 1182. In another embodiment, head 1182 extends above superior surface 1180 even after full insertion through openings 1178 (i.e. stands proud with respect to superior surface 1180). In this embodiment, keel head 1182 can cooperate with a bore or slit provided on the inferior surface of a tibial insert to serve as a centering mechanism for insertion (locking the tibial insert to base 1172 in a fixed bearing design) and/or articulation of the femoral and tibial components (in a mobile bearing design).
If tibial tray 1170 were an integral single-piece unit, it would be difficult to insert tibial tray 1170 through a minimal incision, regardless of the location of the incision. However, since tibial tray 1170 is modular, base 1172 can be readily slid in through either a lateral or medial side incision (which can be smaller than typical mid-line incisions) and, keel 1174 can be interoperatively coupled to base 1172 after base 1172 is in the desired position. Keel 1174 can be inserted through the same incision as base 1172 or through a separate incision. This separate incision can be a substantially anterior incision or an incision located on the same or opposite side as the incision for base 1172. As is well known, tibial tray 1170 can be inserted either with or without bone cement. If bone cement is used, the cement can be placed under base 1172 after it is positioned on tibia 1156 and then keel 1174 is inserted into openings 1178.
Tibial tray 1186 also includes another feature to assist implantation. Specifically, like prior art tibial trays, tibial tray 1186 includes a rim 1191 for retaining the tibial insert or bearing surface. However, as shown, rim 1191 does not extend around the entire perimeter of tibial tray 1186. Specifically, lateral and medial posterior regions 1193 have no rim. A centrally located section 1195 can be provided with a rim for retention of the tibial insert. The elimination of rim 1191 from posterior regions 1193, facilitates implantation of the femoral component as there is no posterior rim in lateral an medial regions 1193 to impede impaction of the femoral component. Section 1195 will not interfere with impaction of the femoral component as the femoral component has a geometry matching the natural condyles of the femur. The novel feature of eliminating the posterior rim can be applied to different tibial tray designs and is not limited to tibial tray 1186.
In order to facilitate implantation of tray 1186, a side cutting or milling jig 1196 (
When viewed from the anterior (
Although tibial trays 1170, 1186, and 1200 are, as the name implies, intended for use in the tibia, the concepts can be applied to the other components in partial or total knee replacement surgeries. For example,
In order to facilitate insertion of femoral component 1224 through a minimally invasive lateral or medial incision, femoral component 1224 can be made modular. This allows femoral component 1224 to be implanted in sections through an incision that would otherwise be much longer which are then coupled in vivo. As shown, femoral component 1224 comprises an anterior femoral section 1234, and a posterior femoral section 1236. However, any desired number of sections could be used. Anterior femoral section 1234 is coupled to posterior femoral section 1236.
Self-Centering Mobile Bearing Implant
Tibial component 1254 includes a tray 1266 and a bearing insert 1268. Tray 1266 is defined by a tapered keel or spike 1270 and a plate member 1272. As previously discussed with respect to other embodiments, other mechanisms for fixing tibial component 1254 can be used as an alternative to spike 1270. Plate member 1272 has a superior surface 1274 defined by a concave, spherically shaped plateau surface.
As is more fully described below, bearing insert 1268 also has a spherically shaped surface so that the interface between tibial tray 1266 and bearing insert 1268 is defined by cooperating spherically shaped, concave and convex surfaces that enable sliding motions along these surfaces. In this regard, superior surface 1274 has a mirror polish to minimize friction during relative slidable movements of bearing insert 1268. Additionally, superior surface 1274 is provided with a track 1276 that cooperates with a groove located on bearing insert 1268 so that the sliding motion occurs substantially in the anterior-posterior direction. Although a single track 1276 is shown centrally located, track 1276 can be located elsewhere along superior surface 1274 and/or more than one track can be used (e.g. two lateral symmetrically placed tracks). Also, the arrangement of the track and groove can be switched so that bearing insert 1268 is provided with the track and superior surface 1274 is provided with the groove.
Bearing insert 1268 has a superior surface 1278 that includes a pair of spaced apart curved depressions 1280 that form bearing surfaces for condyle surfaces 1258 of femoral component 1252. Condyle surfaces 1258 and depressions 1280 are shaped so that pivoting motion between femoral component 1252 and bearing insert 1268 can occur over a wide range of motion. A protrusion 1282 can be located between depressions 1280 so that extension of protrusion 1282 into recess 1262 of femoral component 1252 substantially prevents hyperextension (counterclockwise rotation beyond a certain point) of femoral component 1252. Interference between protrusion 1282 and recess 1262 also prevents relative motion in the lateral-medial direction.
Bearing insert 1268 has an inferior surface 1284 that is convex and spherically shaped and mates with concave superior surface 1274 of tibial tray 1266. A groove 1286 is located on inferior surface 1284 and is configured and dimensioned to receive track 1276.
As is evident from the foregoing, implant 1250 operates like prior art mobile bearing knee implants in the occurrence of sliding motion between bearing insert 1268 and both femoral and tibial tray 1266 components 1252. However, unlike prior art mobile bearing knee implants that rely on tracks and grooves to substantially limit the movement to the anterior-posterior direction, the articulating surfaces are not flat. Rather, superior surface 1274 of tibial tray 1266 and inferior surface 1284 of bearing insert 1268 are mating curved surfaces.
With the prior art flat surfaces, there is increased risk for dislocation and variable degrees of laxity. Additionally, ligament balancing and self-centering of the joint may be more difficult, allowing for some feelings of instability and/or ligamentous laxity. Because superior surface 1274 of tibial tray 1266 and inferior surface 1284 of bearing insert 1268 are mating curved surfaces, the curvature toward the center of the tibia encourages bearing insert 1268 to want to fall back into the center of the curvature of superior surface 1274.
In order to enhance ligament stability, tray 1266 and/or bearing insert 1268 can be made to have a thickness that increases from the center toward the edge. As shown in
The curvature of inferior surface 1284 of bearing insert 1268 can be made to match the curvature of superior surface 1274 of tibial tray 1266. Alternatively, the curvatures can be different. For example, the curvature of inferior surface 1284 can be smaller than the curvature of superior surface 1274. Regardless of whether of curvatures match, the curvature of inferior surface 1284 and/or superior surface 1274 can be constant or have a radius which progressively varies.
Each of femoral component 1252, tibial tray 1266, and bearing insert 1268 can be made of any suitable biocompatible material. For example, femoral component 1252 and tibial tray 1266 can both be made of a metallic material such as a cobalt-chromium alloy or titanium alloy, and bearing insert 1268 can be made of a polymer such as UHMW polyethylene. This provides metal articulating against a polymer. Additionally and as previously discussed with respect to other embodiments, this can be reversed so that femoral component 1252 and tibial tray 1266 are made of a polymer and bearing insert 1268 is made of a metallic material.
Tibial component 1292 includes a tray 1294 and a bearing insert 1296. Tray 1294 includes a tapered spike 1298 and a plate member 1300. As was the case for tibial component 1254, other mechanisms for fixing tibial component 1292 can be used as an alternative to spike 1298. Plate member 1300 has a superior surface 1302 defined by a concave, spherically shaped plateau surface.
Analogous to bearing insert 1268, bearing insert 1296 also has a spherically shaped inferior surface 1304 so that the interface between tibial tray 1294 and bearing insert 1296 is defined by cooperating spherically shaped, concave and convex surfaces that enable sliding motions along these surfaces. In this regard, superior surface 1302 has a mirror polish to minimize friction during relative slidable movements of bearing insert 1296. Additionally, superior surface 1302 is provided with a post 1306 that cooperates with a recess 1308 located on bearing insert 1296 to permit rotation of bearing insert 1296 with respect to tibial tray 1294. The arrangement of the post and recess can be switched so that bearing insert 1296 is provided with the post and superior surface 1302 is provided with the recess.
As is evident from the foregoing, implant 1290 operates like prior art mobile bearing knee implants in the occurrence of rotation motion between bearing insert 1296 and both femoral and tibial tray components 1292. However, unlike prior art mobile bearing knee implants that rely on a post mechanism to control the rotational movement, the articulating surfaces are not flat. Rather, superior surface 1302 of tibial tray 1294 and inferior surface 1304 of bearing insert 1296 are mating curved surfaces.
Compared to the prior art, implant 1290, like implant 1250, provides improved dislocation risk, ligament balancing, and ligament stability. In order to enhance ligament stability, tray 1294 and/or bearing insert 1296 can be made to have a thickness that increases from the center toward the edge. Thus, as bearing insert 1296 slides, both the curvature and decrease in thickness cooperate as a self-centering mechanism that draws bearing insert 1296 back to the center of post 1306 (also resisting posterior rollback), the lowest point in tibial tray 1294 when they are at rest. This enhances stability, yet allows free motion and a mobile bearing construct.
As is evident from
Any of the above-described embodiments of self-centering mechanism can be applied to total or partial knee replacement. These embodiments could be used in any joint, such as the shoulder, ankle, wrist, as well as others.
Bicompartment Implants
As previously discussed (see, e.g.
Arthritis typically does not involve the entire joint space. Most arthritis of the knee is medial joint, lateral joint, patellofemoral joint, or some combination of two of these three joint compartments. Usually advanced arthritis involves both the medial or lateral compartment and the patellofemoral joint. Replacement of the medial or lateral compartment through limited incision surgery and then patellofemoral replacement through the same incision or another incision will lead to faster patient rehabilitation. Additionally, limited incision replacement of these compartments that avoided everting the patellofemoral joint and reduced damage of the quadriceps mechanism would further accelerate rehabilitation.
In the interest of brevity, the reader is referred to
In order to reduce the generation of wear debris, the articulating surfaces can be magnetically charged to have the same polarity so that the surfaces are repelled from each other. Thus, the surfaces glide smoothly over each other, essentially floating with respect to one another. This would also potentially allow a replacement surface that is a strip or point contact, rather than being a full surface that matches the surface of the joint. This embodiment, which is described in more detail below, would include strips that glide along each other, as opposed to a full resurfacing of the joint so one would have strips in contact with each other rather than a full surface. The surface magnetic charges can diminish with time. Additionally, certain environments could also diminish the magnetic charges. For example, exposure to an MRI apparatus could severely alter the magnetic fields. In order to account for these possibilities, the magnetic charges of the articulating surfaces can be re-magnetized.
The present invention also envisions the application of magnetically charged articulating surfaces to other implant designs and to other locations in the body. Examples include the knee, the shoulder (both the glenoid and humeral components), the joints of the hand and wrist, the joints of the foot and ankle, and the spine. With respect to the spine, suitable procedures include any procedure involving the disc space and/or the vertebra.
Adjustable Cutting Jig
As previously discussed, various embodiments of the present invention involve a lateral or medial approach to accessing a joint space.
The cutting jig 1330 is illustrated in
Although either intramedullary or extramedullary instrumentation can be used to attach the cutting jig 1330 to the femur 1334,
A length adjustment member 1340 slides along shaft 1338 so that the location of length adjustment member 1340 on shaft 1338 can be changed to accommodate different anatomies. Tightening knob 1342 can be used to to lock length adjustment member 1340 at the desired location. Length adjustment member 1340 can also freely rotate about shaft axis 1344. This is useful, for example, if a medial approach is to be used.
An arm 1346 extends from length adjustment member 1340. Arm 1346 includes a head 1348 that is received in ring 1350 on length adjustment member 1340. The arm 1346 can be made as two telescoping rods or a similar configuration so that the length of the arm 1346 can be adjusted. The head 1348 can rotate within the ring 1350 to allow rotation of the arm 1346. A tightening knob 1352 locks the arm 1346 at the desired position.
An extension 1354 extends from the lateral end of arm 1346. Like the arm 1346, extension 1354 can be made as two telescoping rods or a similar configuration so that the length of the extension 1354 can be adjusted. A link 1356 is generically shown to indicate that different types of joints can be used to couple the arm 1346 and the extension 1354. For example, it may be desirable to have the extension 1354 rotate and/or pivot with respect to the arm 1346. Regardless of the specific design of the link 1356, a tightening knob 1358 is provided to lock the extension 1354 at the desired position.
A cutting guide 1360 is located on an end of the extension 1354. As was the case for link 1356, different types of joints can be used to couple the cutting guide 1360 to the extension 1354. The cutting guide 1360 includes a distal guide surface 1362, an anterior chamfer guide surface 1364, a posterior chamfer guide surface 1366, an anterior guide surface 1368, and a posterior guide surface 1370. As is readily apparent, the cutting guide 1360 has a structure substantially similar to the cutting guide 800. Furthermore, the operation and use of the cutting guide 1360 is substantially similar to that of the cutting guide 800. Accordingly, reference is made thereto.
Each of the guide surfaces 1362, 1364, 1366, 1368, and 1370 can be made to have a length less than the extent of the cut to be formed on the distal end portion 1332 of the femur 1334. Therefore, after an initial portion of the cut has been made utilizing the appropriate guide surface to guide movement of the cutting tool, the cut surfaces are utilized to guide movement of the cutting tool during completion of the cut. The cutting guide 1360 is not of the capture type. Therefore, the cutting tool is free to move past the guide surfaces 1362, 1364, 1366, 1368, and 1370 during completion of the femoral cuts. If the guide surfaces 1362, 1364, 1366, 1368, and 1370 were formed by slots, the cutting guide 1360 could be disconnected from the femur 1334 to complete the femoral cuts.
The cutting guide 1360 can be made so that one or more of the guide surfaces 1362, 1364, 1366, 1368, and 1370 have an adjustable length so that the size of the guided portion of the cuts can be adjusted depending upon the size of the bone and the implant that is to be used. Furthermore, the cutting guide 1360 is shown having a plurality of guide surfaces 1362, 1364, 1366, 1368, and 1370, with each guide surface being used to make a different cut. Other embodiments of cutting guides 1360 can be used with the cutting jig 1330.
For example,
The base 1376 has a plurality of tracks 1378, 1380, 1382, 1384, and 1386. The guide surface 1374 is attached to a pin member 1388. The pin member 1388 is sized to be received in the tracks 1378, 1380, 1382, 1384, and 1386. When pin member 1388 is located in the track 1378, the guide surface 1374 is positioned on the femur for making an anterior cut, as shown in
The pin member 1388 can be locked in the tracks 1378, 1380, 1382, 1384, and 1386 to stabilize the guide surface 1374 during making of the cuts. This can be done in any number of ways. For example, the pin member 1388 can have a threaded portion that receives a nut to secure the pin member 1388 within the track. The specific configuration of the tracks 1378, 1380, 1382, 1384, and 1386 shown in
As was the case with the cutting guide 1360, the guide surface 1374 can be made so that the size of the guided portion of the cuts can be adjusted depending upon the size of the bone and the implant that is to be used. Furthermore, the guide surface 1374 can be made to have a length less than the extent of the cut to be formed on the distal end portion of the femur. Therefore, after initial portions of the cuts have been made utilizing the guide surface 1374 to guide movement of the cutting tool, the cut surfaces are utilized to guide movement of the cutting tool during completion of the cut. The cutting guide 1372 is not of the capture type. Therefore, the cutting tool is free to move past the guide surface 1374 during completion of the femoral cuts. If the guide surface 1374 were of the capture type (having a slot), the cutting guide 1372 could be disconnected from the femur to complete the femoral cuts.
The cutting guide 1372 is illustrated in
Implants with Reduced Articulating Surfaces
As previously detailed, the present invention relates to methods, implants, and instrumentation for performing surgery through minimally invasive procedures. One aspect is the insertion of a partial or total joint replacement implant through a minimally invasive incision. For example, modular implants that are assembled after insertion in the body can typically be more easily inserted through a smaller incision than a unitary implant of the same size or a modular implant that is assembled prior to implantation. Thus, it is advantageous to have smaller implants, modular or not, in order to reduce the size of the incision that is needed for implantation.
Smaller implants will generally have a smaller articulating surface area. While prior art prosthetic components provide a low-friction articulating surface for the surface of accompanying member, interaction between the articulating component and the member can produce wear debris. Such debris may cause adverse local and systemic reactions in the body. Thus, it is advantageous to minimize the articulating surface area of one or both of a joint component.
Body 1404 includes a threaded region 1406 for fixing implant 1400 to tissue. A joining region 1408 is located between head 1402 and threaded region 1406. Joining region 1408 is provided with multiple surfaces so that an inserter or other tool can be used to thread implant 1400 into tissue. By providing an area separate from head 1402 that is used for insertion, the risk of scratching or otherwise damaging the bearing surface is reduced.
Threaded region 1406 can be eliminated and other mechanisms for attaching implant 1400 can be used. For example, implant 1400 could simply be driven into the tissue. Bone cement or an adhesive could be used to attach implant 1400. Alternatively, body 1404 could have a rivet type means, an expandable portion, or some other known fixation means.
Implant 1400 can be made from any biocompatible material that will undergo articulating movement with a corresponding natural or prosthetic member. For example, the bearing component could be formed from a variety of metals, polymers, ceramics, or composite materials. In the event that polymers are chosen, a high density polyethylene may be used, although numerous types of polymers may be suitable so long as the material provides both strength and a low-friction articulation surface for the corresponding joint face. If desired, head 1402 and body 1404 can be made of different materials. It may also be advantageous to include some type of known tissue in-growth promoting features on at least a portion of body 1404. Such features include a porous or textured surface, a porous body (for example so-called “foam metals”), and osteoinductive or osteoconductive materials or factors.
Although any number of implants 1400 can be used for a given application, the use of three implants 1400 for acetabulum 1102 may be preferable as three implants serve as a centering mechanism for femoral component 1403. In this regard, the number and location of implants 1400 can be selected to suit a particular application. The size of implants 1400, and in particular head 1402, can also be varied. In acetabulum 1102, smaller heads 3-6 mm in diameter or larger heads 10-15 mm in diameter may be desirable.
Although
Disposable Trial Implants, Instruments, and Other Surgical Implements
As previously discussed throughout this specification, the present invention includes disposable surgical implants and instruments. Currently for hip, knee, shoulder, and other joint replacement surgeries (partial or total), there can be six or more trays of instruments and trial implants. Each tray has to be re-sterilized for each procedure. In the case of knee replacement surgeries, one tray may contain femoral trials, one may contain tibial trials, one may contain polyethylene spacer blocks, one may contain tibial cutting instruments, and one tray may contain femoral cutting instruments.
This is cumbersome and unnecessary as only a few of these instruments and trial implants need to be made of surgical grade metal and alloys that are rigid and reusable. There is a significant expense in the multiple tray setups. One company, for example, spends over $150 million just to have instruments in the field. Additionally, shipping charges and re-sterilization costs can be significant. The delay due to the shipping and re-sterilization also adds hidden costs and time. Obviously, money and time can be saved if the number of trays for each procedure were reduced.
Also, as a company modifies implant systems or instruments, representatives of the company need to update their inventories accordingly. Frequently, companies are unable to charge for the new instruments as an incentive to promote a new system. Although these costs cannot be recovered, they ultimately add to the cost of joint replacement surgeries.
These issues can be addressed by a disposable trailing system. For example, the tibial trial base plate 270 (
The use of disposable trial implants would reduce the number of trays needed for a given procedure. The use of disposable cutting blocks would further reduce the number of trays. In this regard, the disposable cutting blocks could be made of a material that has color or some other chemical or physical property that would allow the detection of trace amounts of the cutting blocks. This is particularly useful if the cutting blocks are inadvertently scratched so that any debris could be detected and removed. The instruments and trials could have changeable lugs, changeable stems, or similar modularity to allow modification of the position and the rotation.
If desired, some or all of the instruments and other disposables could be packaged in a single sterile unit. Some items that could be included in the unit include the instruments, draping, cement, cement mixer, pulsatile lavage, retractors, drill bits, pins, and guide wires. This would save significant time for the operating personnel as they open this unit and it has all the cutting blocks.
One advantage of the disposable system is that the disposable cutting blocks could easily be modified for new or updated instrumentation or for customized instrumentation. The disposable system saves the cost and time of cleaning and re-sterilization. Also, the disposable system would improve the sterile technique in the operating room and since these are single use and sterilized there is no risk of cross-contamination going from one patient to another patient.
If desired, only a portion of the trial implants or instrumentation could be disposable. For example, the intramedullary rod for distal femoral cutting blocks could be reusable, however, the actual cutting surface, such as the captured guide 4 in 1 block, the mill cut, etc., could be disposable.
Program for Learning Minimally Invasive Surgical Techniques
As the minimally invasive surgical instruments, implants, systems, and methods disclosed herein represent a significant deviation from those used in open surgical procedures, the present invention includes a program for training surgeons and other health care professionals. The program is a sequential approach in which the trainee starts the training process using an incision of standard length and progressively decreases the incision size as milestones are achieved.
The program is sequential learning, analogous to returning to residency or a mini-fellowship. The program can involve a series of visits to a dedicated training sites and/or remote linking, for example via videoconferences or the Internet, to certain training programs. The goal of the program is to allow the trainee to progress from: working with a standard incision, traditionally to learn anatomy; working through a smaller incision, with a combination of prior art instruments and implants and the downsized instruments and implants according to the present invention; and working through a minimally invasive incision to use the instruments, implants, systems, and techniques according to the present invention. As previously discussed, these techniques include minimizing or avoiding joint dislocation, video and fluoroscopic or other radiographic guidance, computer assisted surgical procedures, cannulated instruments and implants, and downsized instruments and implants.
The program can include the following training tools, in any combination: lectures and video demonstrations to understand the instruments, both intra and extramedullary, implants, systems, and methods; observation and discussion of live broadcast surgeries; practice using saw bones; practice with cadavers, animal models, or plastic models that have artificial skin, muscle, tissue, ligaments, and bones; virtual reality evaluations; and practice with minimal incisions.
Once proficiency with some or all of the training tools have be achieved, which can be determined by grading based on examination, the trainee can be assigned a mentor, a previously certified health care professional. The trainee can be required to visit and observe the mentor during surgery. Additionally, the mentor could visit the trainee at the trainee's practice and supervise or otherwise monitor the trainee's techniques.
Even after the initial visits between the mentor and trainee, the mentor could be available for consultation by the trainee. The trainee could start probationary work at his practice by initially using an incision that is only slightly smaller than standard incisions. The x-rays, inter-operative pictures or videos, and other case data could be reviewed and graded by the mentor or other certified instructor. Advancement to the next level would only be allowed if the review were satisfactory. The next level could involve a return to some or all of the training tools to practice working through a smaller incision, with a combination of prior art instruments and implants and the downsized instruments and implants according to the present invention. After the training tools are mastered, probationary work by the trainee at this level would be followed by review and grading by the mentor or other certified instructor. Once again, advancement to the next level would only be allowed if the review were satisfactory. The process is repeated for the final level.
The program could be implemented so that the trainee must meet given standards in order to receive instrumentation and implants to allow the trainee to perform the procedures independently without supervision. Furthermore, achieving these standards could be required prior to being allowed to promote or advertise proficiency in the techniques. The standards could be coordinated with hospital Institutional Review Boards.
The program could be offered through a professional society, such as the American Academy of Orthopaedic Surgeons and the Hip and Knee Society, a commercial entity, or some combination thereof. Continuing Medical Education (CME) credits and grades could be provided. The instructors and preceptors could be certified, with the certification process through a professional society.
The trainees could pay a portion of the costs of the program. Trainees would offset the costs of the program from the added revenue from the procedures and possible lower insurance premiums. The costs of the program may be subsidized by governmental agencies and commercial entities, which would benefit from sales and leasing of instruments and implants. Costs could be subsidized by insurers, which would benefit from the lower costs of the procedures compared to traditional open procedures. Finally, costs could also be subsidized by surgical centers, which would benefit from having trained personnel and added revenue from the procedures.
In additional to the educational benefits of the program, the program also provides some legal protection to the trainees. Perhaps more importantly, the program affords protection to the patient by ensuring adequately trained medical personnel.
In view of the foregoing description, it is apparent that the present invention relates to a new and improved method and apparatus for use in performing any desired type of surgery on a joint in a patient's body. The joint may advantageously be a joint in a knee portion 76 of a patient's leg 70. However, the method and apparatus may be used in association with surgery on other joints in a patient's body. There are many different features of the present invention which may used either together or separately in association with many different types of surgery. Although features of the present invention may be used with many different surgical procedures, the invention is described herein in conjunction with surgery on a joint in a patient's body.
One of the features of the present invention relates to the making of a limited incision 114. The limited incision 114 may be in any desired portion of a patient's body. For example, the limited incision 114 may be in a knee portion 76 of a leg 70 of a patient. The limited incision 114 may be made while a lower portion 68 of the leg 70 of the patient is extending downward from the upper portion 72 of the leg of the patient. At this time, a foot 74 connected with the lower portion 68 of the leg of the patient may be below a surface 64 on which the patient is supported. The limited incision 114 may be made while the lower portion 68 of the leg 70 of the patient is suspended from the upper portion of the leg or while the lower portion of the leg and/or the foot 74 of the patient are held by a support device. After the incision 114 has been made, any one of many surgical procedures may be undertaken.
It is believed that in certain circumstances, it may be desired to have a main incision 114 of limited length and a secondary incision 920 of even smaller length. The secondary incision 920 may be a portal or stab wound. A cutting tool 170 may be moved through the secondary incision 920. An implant 286, 290 and/or 294 may be moved through the main incision 114.
Once the incision 114 has been made, a patella 120 in the knee portion 76 of the patient may be offset to one side of its normal position. When the patella 120 is offset, an inner side 122 of the patella faces inward toward the end portions 124 and 212 of a femur 126 and tibia 214.
Although any one of many known surgical procedures may be undertaken through the limited incision 114, down sized instrumentation 134, 138, 186, 210 and/or 218 for use in the making of cuts in a femur 126 and/or tibia 214 may be moved through or part way through the incision. The down sized instrumentation may be smaller than implants 286, 290 and/or 294 to be positioned in the knee portion 76 of the patient. The down sized instrumentation 286, 290 and/or 294 may have opposite ends which are spaced apart by a distance which is less than the distance between lateral and medial epicondyles on a femur or tibia in the leg of the patient.
It is contemplated that the down sized instrumentation 134, 138, 186, 210 and/or 218 may have cutting tool guide surfaces of reduced length. The length of the cutting tool guide surfaces may be less than the length of a cut to be made on a bone. A cut on a bone in the patient may be completed using previously cut surfaces as a guide for the cutting tool.
It is contemplated that at least some, if not all, cuts on a bone may be made using light directed onto the bone as a guide. The light directed onto the bone may be in the form of a three dimensional image 850. The light directed onto the bone may be a beam 866 or 868 along which a cutting tool 170 is moved into engagement with the bone.
There are several different orders in which cuts may be made on bones in the knee portion of the leg of the patient. It is believed that it may be advantageous to make the patellar and tibial cuts before making the femoral cuts.
There are many different reasons to check ligament balancing in a knee portion 76 of the leg of a patient. Ligament balancing may be checked while the knee portion 76 of the leg 70 of the patient is flexed and the foot 74 of the patient is below the support surface 64 on which the patient is disposed. Flexion and extension balancing of ligaments may be checked by varying the extent of flexion of the knee portion 76 of the leg 70 of the patient. In addition, rotational stability of the ligaments may be checked by rotating the lower portion of the leg of the patient about its central axis. Balancing of ligaments may also be checked by moving the foot 74 of the patient sideways, rotating the lower portion 68 of the leg 70 of the patient, and/or moving the foot anteriorly or posteriorly.
It is believed that it may be advantageous to utilize an endoscope 352 or a similar apparatus to examine portions of the patient's body which are spaced from the incision 114. It is also contemplated that images of the knee portion of the patient's leg may be obtained by using any one of many known image generating devices other than an endoscope 352. The images may be obtained while the patient's leg 70 is stationary or in motion. The images may be obtained to assist a surgeon in conducting any desired type of surgery.
Balancing of the ligaments in the knee portion 76 of a patient's leg 70 may be facilitated by the positioning of one or more transducers 596 and/or 598 between tendons, ligaments, and/or bones in the knee portion. One transducer 598 may be positioned relative to a medial side of a knee joint. Another transducer 596 may be positioned relative to a lateral side of the knee joint. During bending of the knee joint, the output from the transducers 596 and 598 will vary as a function of variations in tension forces in the ligaments. This enables the tension forces in ligaments in opposite sides of the knee portion to be compared to facilitate balancing of the ligaments.
Patellar tracking may be checked by the positioning of one or more transducers 930 and/or 932 between the patella 120 and the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. If desired, one transducer 932 may be placed between a medial portion of the patella 120 and the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. A second transducer 930 may be placed between a lateral portion of the patella 120 and the distal end portion 124 of the femur 126. Output signals from a transducer 930 will vary as a function of variations in force transmitted between the patella 120 and femur 126 during bending of the leg.
The articular surface 122 on the patella 120 may be repaired. The defective original articular surface 122 on the patella 120 may be removed by cutting the patella while an inner side of the patella faces toward a distal end portion 124 of a femur 126. The step of cutting the patella may be performed while the patella is disposed in situ and is urged toward the distal end portion of the femur by connective tissue. An implant may then be positioned on the patella 120.
It is contemplated that the size of the incision 114 in the knee or other portion of the patient may be minimized by conducting surgery through a cannula 564. The cannula 564 may be expandable. To facilitate moving of an implant 286, 290 and/or 294 through the cannula 564, the implant may be formed in two or more portions 572 and 574. The portions of the implant 286, 290 and/or 294 may be interconnected when the portions of the implant have been positioned in the patient's body. Although the implants disclosed herein are associated with a patient's knee, it should be understood that the implants may be positioned at any desired location in a patient's body.
An implant 626, 640 or 670 may be positioned in a recess 610, 642 or 672 formed in a bone 126 or 214 in a patient. The implant 626, 640 or 670 may contain biological resurfacing and/or bone growth promoting materials. The implant 626, 640 and/or 670 may contain mesenchymal cells and/or tissue inductive factors. Alternatively, the implant 626 or 640 may be formed of one or more materials which do not enable bone to grow into the implant.
In accordance with one of the features of the present invention, body tissue may be moved or stretched by a device 720, 722 and/or 730 which is expandable. The expandable device 720, 722 and/or 730 may be biodegradable so that it can be left in a patient's body. The expandable device 720, 722 and/or 730 may be expanded to move and/or stretch body tissue and increase a range of motion of a joint. The expandable device may be used to stretch body tissue in which an incision is to be made.
An improved drape system 100 is provided to maintain a sterile field between a surgeon 106 and a patient during movement of the surgeon relative to the patient. The improved drape system 100 includes a drape 102 which extends between the surgeon and a drape 90 for the patient. During surgery on a knee portion 76 of a leg 70 of a patient, the drape system 100 extends beneath the foot portion 74 of the leg 70 of a patient. It is contemplated that the drape system 100 will be utilized during many different types of operations other than surgery on a leg of a patient.
An implant 950, 970, 980, 1002, 1020, 1040 or 1060 may be movable relative to both a femur 126 and a tibia 214 in a leg of a patient during bending of the leg. The implant may include a single member (
There are many different features to the present invention. It is contemplated that these features may be used together or separately. It is also contemplated that the features may be utilized in association with joints in a patient's body other than a knee joint. For example, features of the present invention may be used in association with surgery on vertebral joints or glenoid joints. However, it is believed that many of the features may be advantageously utilized together during the performance of surgery on a patient's knee. However, the invention should not be limited to any particular combination of features or to surgery on any particular joint in a patient's body. It is contemplated that features of the present invention will be used in association with surgery which is not performed on a joint in a patient's body.
Thus, while various descriptions of the present invention are described above, it should be understood that the various features can be used singly or in any combination thereof. Therefore, this invention is not to be limited to only the specifically preferred embodiments depicted herein. Further, it should be understood that variations and modifications within the spirit and scope of the invention may occur to those skilled in the art to which the invention pertains. Accordingly, all expedient modifications readily attainable by one versed in the art from the disclosure set forth herein that are within the scope and spirit of the present invention are to be included as further embodiments of the present invention. The scope of the present invention is accordingly defined as set forth in the appended claims.
This application is continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/407,448 filed Feb. 28, 2012, which is continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 13/221,033 filed Aug. 30, 2011, which is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/795,935 filed Jun. 8, 2010, which is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/684,103 filed Mar. 9, 2007, now U.S. Pat. No. 7,828,852, which is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/681,526 filed Oct. 8, 2003, which is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 10/191,751 filed Jul. 8, 2002, now U.S. Pat. No. 7,104,996, which is a continuation-in-part of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 09/976,396 filed Oct. 11, 2001, now U.S. Pat. No. 6,770,078, Ser. No. 09/941,185 filed Aug. 28, 2001, now U.S. Pat. No. 6,702,821, Ser. No. 09/566,070 filed May 5, 2000, now U.S. Pat. No. 6,575,982, Ser. No. 09/737,380 filed Dec. 15, 2000, now U.S. Pat. No. 6,503,267, Ser. No. 09/569,020 filed May 11, 2000, now U.S. Pat. No. 6,423,063, Ser. No. 09/483,676 filed Jan. 14, 2000, now U.S. Pat. No. 6,468,289, Ser. No. 09/798,870 filed Mar. 1, 2000, now U.S. Pat. No. 6,503,277, Ser. No. 09/526,949 filed on Mar. 16, 2000, now U.S. Pat. No. 6,620,181, and Ser. No. 09/789,621 filed Feb. 21, 2001, now U.S. Pat. No. 6,635,073.
Number | Name | Date | Kind |
---|---|---|---|
1920821 | Wassenaar | Aug 1933 | A |
2589720 | Aubaniac | Mar 1952 | A |
3229006 | Nohl | Jan 1966 | A |
3624747 | McKnight | Nov 1971 | A |
3715763 | Link | Feb 1973 | A |
3750652 | Sherwin | Aug 1973 | A |
3774244 | Walker | Nov 1973 | A |
3807393 | McDonald | Apr 1974 | A |
3811449 | Gravlee et al. | May 1974 | A |
3852830 | Marmor | Dec 1974 | A |
3858578 | Milo | Jan 1975 | A |
3869731 | Waugh et al. | Mar 1975 | A |
3903549 | Deyerle | Sep 1975 | A |
3911923 | Yoon | Oct 1975 | A |
3916451 | Buechel et al. | Nov 1975 | A |
3920022 | Pastor | Nov 1975 | A |
3949428 | Cavendish et al. | Apr 1976 | A |
3967625 | Yoon | Jul 1976 | A |
3989049 | Yoon | Nov 1976 | A |
3991426 | Flom | Nov 1976 | A |
3994287 | Turp | Nov 1976 | A |
4000525 | Klawitter | Jan 1977 | A |
4038704 | Ring | Aug 1977 | A |
4053953 | Flom | Oct 1977 | A |
4085466 | Goodfellow | Apr 1978 | A |
4085743 | Yoon | Apr 1978 | A |
4103680 | Yoon | Aug 1978 | A |
RE29757 | Helfet | Sep 1978 | E |
4169470 | Ender et al. | Oct 1979 | A |
4203444 | Bonnell | May 1980 | A |
4209012 | Smucker | Jun 1980 | A |
4209861 | Walker | Jul 1980 | A |
4213209 | Insall | Jul 1980 | A |
4219893 | Noiles | Sep 1980 | A |
4220146 | Cloutier | Sep 1980 | A |
4224696 | Murray et al. | Sep 1980 | A |
4263904 | Judet | Apr 1981 | A |
4298992 | Burstein et al. | Nov 1981 | A |
4299224 | Noiles | Nov 1981 | A |
4309778 | Buechel | Jan 1982 | A |
4311145 | Esty | Jan 1982 | A |
4344193 | Kenny | Aug 1982 | A |
4349018 | Chambers | Sep 1982 | A |
4355429 | Mittelmeier et al. | Oct 1982 | A |
4364382 | Mennen | Dec 1982 | A |
4369768 | Vukovic | Jan 1983 | A |
4373709 | Whitt | Feb 1983 | A |
4374523 | Yoon | Feb 1983 | A |
4385404 | Sully | May 1983 | A |
4421112 | Mains et al. | Dec 1983 | A |
4457302 | Caspari et al. | Jul 1984 | A |
4457307 | Stillwell | Jul 1984 | A |
4463753 | Gustilo | Aug 1984 | A |
4474177 | Whiteside | Oct 1984 | A |
4487203 | Androphy | Dec 1984 | A |
4501266 | McDaniel | Feb 1985 | A |
4502161 | Wall | Mar 1985 | A |
4502483 | Lacey | Mar 1985 | A |
4509518 | McGarry | Apr 1985 | A |
4524766 | Petersen | Jun 1985 | A |
4545375 | Cline | Oct 1985 | A |
4565192 | Shapiro | Jan 1986 | A |
4567885 | Androphy | Feb 1986 | A |
4567886 | Petersen | Feb 1986 | A |
4574794 | Cooke et al. | Mar 1986 | A |
4574994 | Rauchwerger | Mar 1986 | A |
4619391 | Sharkany | Oct 1986 | A |
4624250 | Saunders et al. | Nov 1986 | A |
4624254 | McGarry | Nov 1986 | A |
4640271 | Lower | Feb 1987 | A |
4641648 | Shapiro | Feb 1987 | A |
4646738 | Trott | Mar 1987 | A |
4662372 | Sharkany | May 1987 | A |
4662887 | Turner et al. | May 1987 | A |
4682598 | Beraha | Jul 1987 | A |
4685460 | Thornton | Aug 1987 | A |
4703751 | Pohl | Nov 1987 | A |
4712542 | Daniel et al. | Dec 1987 | A |
4719908 | Averill | Jan 1988 | A |
4721104 | Kaufman | Jan 1988 | A |
4738253 | Buechel et al. | Apr 1988 | A |
4739751 | Sapega et al. | Apr 1988 | A |
4743261 | Epinette | May 1988 | A |
4759350 | Dunn et al. | Jul 1988 | A |
4769040 | Wevers | Sep 1988 | A |
4773407 | Petersen | Sep 1988 | A |
4778469 | Lin et al. | Oct 1988 | A |
4787383 | Kenna | Nov 1988 | A |
4791934 | Brunnett | Dec 1988 | A |
4817602 | Beraha | Apr 1989 | A |
4825857 | Kenna | May 1989 | A |
4841975 | Woolson | Jun 1989 | A |
4865607 | Witzel et al. | Sep 1989 | A |
4880429 | Stone | Nov 1989 | A |
4892552 | Ainsworth et al. | Jan 1990 | A |
4901711 | Goble et al. | Feb 1990 | A |
4902508 | Badylak et al. | Feb 1990 | A |
4911721 | Branemark et al. | Mar 1990 | A |
4919671 | Karpf | Apr 1990 | A |
4935023 | Whiteside | Jun 1990 | A |
4936852 | Kent | Jun 1990 | A |
4938762 | Wehrli | Jul 1990 | A |
4944760 | Kenna | Jul 1990 | A |
4945896 | Gade | Aug 1990 | A |
4950298 | Gustilo | Aug 1990 | A |
4952213 | Bowman et al. | Aug 1990 | A |
4961954 | Goldberg | Oct 1990 | A |
4963152 | Hofmann et al. | Oct 1990 | A |
4963153 | Noesberger et al. | Oct 1990 | A |
4964865 | Burkhead | Oct 1990 | A |
4968316 | Hergenroeder | Nov 1990 | A |
4979949 | Matsen et al. | Dec 1990 | A |
4983179 | Sjostrom | Jan 1991 | A |
4985038 | Lyell | Jan 1991 | A |
5002547 | Poggie et al. | Mar 1991 | A |
5007912 | Albrektsson et al. | Apr 1991 | A |
5017139 | Mushabac | May 1991 | A |
5019104 | Whiteside et al. | May 1991 | A |
5021056 | Hofmann et al. | Jun 1991 | A |
5032132 | Matsen | Jul 1991 | A |
5035699 | Coates | Jul 1991 | A |
5037423 | Kenna | Aug 1991 | A |
5049149 | Schmidt | Sep 1991 | A |
5053039 | Hofmann et al. | Oct 1991 | A |
5060678 | Bauman | Oct 1991 | A |
5064439 | Chang et al. | Nov 1991 | A |
5086401 | Glassman et al. | Feb 1992 | A |
5098436 | Ferrante et al. | Mar 1992 | A |
5098437 | Kashuba | Mar 1992 | A |
5099859 | Bell | Mar 1992 | A |
5100409 | Coates | Mar 1992 | A |
5100689 | Goldberg | Mar 1992 | A |
5108441 | McDowell | Apr 1992 | A |
5111987 | Moeinzadeh | May 1992 | A |
5122144 | Bert | Jun 1992 | A |
5123906 | Kelman | Jun 1992 | A |
5152744 | Krause | Oct 1992 | A |
5152778 | Bales | Oct 1992 | A |
5154717 | Matsen, II et al. | Oct 1992 | A |
5163842 | Nonomura | Nov 1992 | A |
5163949 | Bonutti | Nov 1992 | A |
5170800 | Smith | Dec 1992 | A |
5171243 | Kashuba | Dec 1992 | A |
5171244 | Caspari et al. | Dec 1992 | A |
5171276 | Caspari | Dec 1992 | A |
5174300 | Bales | Dec 1992 | A |
5176684 | Ferrante et al. | Jan 1993 | A |
5176702 | Bales | Jan 1993 | A |
5178622 | Lehner | Jan 1993 | A |
5180383 | Haydon | Jan 1993 | A |
5183053 | Yeh | Feb 1993 | A |
5183464 | Dubrul et al. | Feb 1993 | A |
5186178 | Yeh | Feb 1993 | A |
5197488 | Kovacevic | Mar 1993 | A |
5197968 | Clement | Mar 1993 | A |
5197971 | Bonutti | Mar 1993 | A |
5197987 | Koch | Mar 1993 | A |
5207680 | Dietz et al. | May 1993 | A |
5207692 | Kraus | May 1993 | A |
5217463 | Mikhail | Jun 1993 | A |
5226915 | Bertin | Jul 1993 | A |
5228459 | Caspari et al. | Jul 1993 | A |
5234433 | Bert et al. | Aug 1993 | A |
5236432 | Matsen, III et al. | Aug 1993 | A |
5250050 | Poggie et al. | Oct 1993 | A |
5254119 | Schreiber | Oct 1993 | A |
5258004 | Bales | Nov 1993 | A |
5258032 | Bertin | Nov 1993 | A |
5259398 | Vrespa | Nov 1993 | A |
5263498 | Caspari | Nov 1993 | A |
5263987 | Shah | Nov 1993 | A |
5269785 | Bonutti | Dec 1993 | A |
5273524 | Fox | Dec 1993 | A |
5274565 | Reuben | Dec 1993 | A |
5275166 | Vaitekunas | Jan 1994 | A |
5275603 | Ferrante et al. | Jan 1994 | A |
5279309 | Taylor et al. | Jan 1994 | A |
5281422 | Badylak et al. | Jan 1994 | A |
5282803 | Lackey | Feb 1994 | A |
5282861 | Kaplan | Feb 1994 | A |
5282866 | Cohen et al. | Feb 1994 | A |
5285773 | Bonutti | Feb 1994 | A |
5293878 | Bales | Mar 1994 | A |
5295994 | Bonutti | Mar 1994 | A |
5299288 | Glassman et al. | Mar 1994 | A |
5304181 | Caspari et al. | Apr 1994 | A |
5306276 | Johnson et al. | Apr 1994 | A |
5306311 | Stone | Apr 1994 | A |
5308349 | Mikhail | May 1994 | A |
5312411 | Steele | May 1994 | A |
5314482 | Goodfellow | May 1994 | A |
5320611 | Bonutti et al. | Jun 1994 | A |
5322505 | Krause | Jun 1994 | A |
5326361 | Hollister | Jul 1994 | A |
5342368 | Petersen | Aug 1994 | A |
5344423 | Dietz et al. | Sep 1994 | A |
5344458 | Bonutti | Sep 1994 | A |
5348541 | Lyell | Sep 1994 | A |
5358530 | Hodorek | Oct 1994 | A |
5360016 | Kovacevic | Nov 1994 | A |
5364401 | Ferrante et al. | Nov 1994 | A |
5364402 | Mumme et al. | Nov 1994 | A |
5368599 | Hirsch | Nov 1994 | A |
5379133 | Kirk | Jan 1995 | A |
5395376 | Caspari | Mar 1995 | A |
5395377 | Petersen et al. | Mar 1995 | A |
5395401 | Bahler | Mar 1995 | A |
5397323 | Taylor et al. | Mar 1995 | A |
5399951 | Lavallee et al. | Mar 1995 | A |
5403319 | Matsen, III et al. | Apr 1995 | A |
5405395 | Coates | Apr 1995 | A |
5408409 | Glassman et al. | Apr 1995 | A |
D358647 | Cohen | May 1995 | S |
5415663 | Luckman | May 1995 | A |
5417694 | Marik et al. | May 1995 | A |
5417695 | Axelson, Jr. | May 1995 | A |
5423823 | Schmieding | Jun 1995 | A |
5425355 | Kulick | Jun 1995 | A |
5425745 | Green | Jun 1995 | A |
5425775 | Kovacevic | Jun 1995 | A |
5445639 | Kuslich et al. | Aug 1995 | A |
5445640 | Johnson et al. | Aug 1995 | A |
5445642 | McNulty et al. | Aug 1995 | A |
5448489 | Reuben | Sep 1995 | A |
5451228 | Johnson et al. | Sep 1995 | A |
5454365 | Bonutti | Oct 1995 | A |
5454815 | Geisser | Oct 1995 | A |
5454816 | Ashby | Oct 1995 | A |
5456268 | Bonutti | Oct 1995 | A |
5456720 | Schultz | Oct 1995 | A |
5458643 | Oka et al. | Oct 1995 | A |
5462549 | Glock | Oct 1995 | A |
5464406 | Ritter et al. | Nov 1995 | A |
5470354 | Hershberger | Nov 1995 | A |
5472415 | King | Dec 1995 | A |
5474559 | Bertin | Dec 1995 | A |
5484095 | Green | Jan 1996 | A |
5486178 | Hodge | Jan 1996 | A |
5486180 | Dietz et al. | Jan 1996 | A |
5490854 | Fisher et al. | Feb 1996 | A |
5497933 | Defonzo | Mar 1996 | A |
5514139 | Goldstein | May 1996 | A |
5514140 | Lackey | May 1996 | A |
5514141 | Prizzi | May 1996 | A |
5514143 | Bonutti et al. | May 1996 | A |
5514153 | Bonutti | May 1996 | A |
5520692 | Ferrante | May 1996 | A |
5520694 | Dance et al. | May 1996 | A |
5520695 | Luckman | May 1996 | A |
5522897 | King | Jun 1996 | A |
5527343 | Bonutti | Jun 1996 | A |
5527353 | Schmitt | Jun 1996 | A |
5540695 | Levy | Jul 1996 | A |
5540696 | Booth | Jul 1996 | A |
5542947 | Treacy | Aug 1996 | A |
5549683 | Bonutti | Aug 1996 | A |
5549689 | Epstein et al. | Aug 1996 | A |
5554169 | Green | Sep 1996 | A |
5562675 | McNulty et al. | Oct 1996 | A |
5569163 | Francis | Oct 1996 | A |
5569259 | Ferrante et al. | Oct 1996 | A |
5569260 | Petersen | Oct 1996 | A |
5569261 | Marik et al. | Oct 1996 | A |
5569578 | Mushabac | Oct 1996 | A |
5570700 | Vogeler | Nov 1996 | A |
5571196 | Stein | Nov 1996 | A |
5577502 | Darrow et al. | Nov 1996 | A |
5578039 | Vendrely et al. | Nov 1996 | A |
5593448 | Dong | Jan 1997 | A |
5597379 | Haines | Jan 1997 | A |
5601563 | Burke et al. | Feb 1997 | A |
5601565 | Huebner | Feb 1997 | A |
5601566 | Dance et al. | Feb 1997 | A |
5609603 | Linden | Mar 1997 | A |
5609644 | Ashby et al. | Mar 1997 | A |
5611764 | Bonutti et al. | Mar 1997 | A |
5611802 | Samuelson et al. | Mar 1997 | A |
5613969 | Jenkins, Jr. | Mar 1997 | A |
5624444 | Wixon et al. | Apr 1997 | A |
5624463 | Stone | Apr 1997 | A |
5628749 | Vendrely et al. | May 1997 | A |
5628750 | Whitlock et al. | May 1997 | A |
5630431 | Taylor | May 1997 | A |
5632745 | Schwartz | May 1997 | A |
5638819 | Manwaring et al. | Jun 1997 | A |
5643272 | Haines et al. | Jul 1997 | A |
5649946 | Bramlet | Jul 1997 | A |
5658292 | Axelson | Aug 1997 | A |
5662111 | Cosman | Sep 1997 | A |
5662656 | White | Sep 1997 | A |
5662710 | Bonutti | Sep 1997 | A |
5667069 | Williams | Sep 1997 | A |
5667511 | Vendrely et al. | Sep 1997 | A |
5667512 | Johnson | Sep 1997 | A |
5667520 | Bonutti | Sep 1997 | A |
5669914 | Eckhoff | Sep 1997 | A |
5676668 | McCue et al. | Oct 1997 | A |
5676673 | Ferre et al. | Oct 1997 | A |
5681316 | DeOrio | Oct 1997 | A |
5682886 | Delp et al. | Nov 1997 | A |
5683396 | Tokish et al. | Nov 1997 | A |
5683397 | Vendrely et al. | Nov 1997 | A |
5683469 | Johnson | Nov 1997 | A |
5688279 | McNulty et al. | Nov 1997 | A |
5690635 | Matsen, III et al. | Nov 1997 | A |
5695500 | Taylor et al. | Dec 1997 | A |
5702447 | Walch | Dec 1997 | A |
5702475 | Zahedi | Dec 1997 | A |
5704941 | Jacober et al. | Jan 1998 | A |
5707350 | Krause | Jan 1998 | A |
5709689 | Ferrante et al. | Jan 1998 | A |
5712543 | Sjostrom | Jan 1998 | A |
5715836 | Kliegis | Feb 1998 | A |
5716360 | Baldwin et al. | Feb 1998 | A |
5716361 | Masini | Feb 1998 | A |
5718708 | Webb | Feb 1998 | A |
5718717 | Bonutti | Feb 1998 | A |
5720752 | Elliott | Feb 1998 | A |
5722978 | Jenkins | Mar 1998 | A |
5723016 | Minns et al. | Mar 1998 | A |
5723331 | Tubo | Mar 1998 | A |
5725530 | Popken | Mar 1998 | A |
5730129 | Darrow et al. | Mar 1998 | A |
5732821 | Stone et al. | Mar 1998 | A |
5733292 | Gustilo et al. | Mar 1998 | A |
5735904 | Pappas | Apr 1998 | A |
5741264 | Cipolletti | Apr 1998 | A |
5743915 | Bertin et al. | Apr 1998 | A |
5748767 | Raab | May 1998 | A |
5749876 | Duvillier et al. | May 1998 | A |
5755731 | Grinberg | May 1998 | A |
5755791 | Whitson et al. | May 1998 | A |
5755801 | Walker | May 1998 | A |
5755803 | Haines | May 1998 | A |
5763416 | Bonadio | Jun 1998 | A |
5769092 | Williamson, Jr. | Jun 1998 | A |
5769640 | Jacobus et al. | Jun 1998 | A |
5769854 | Bastian et al. | Jun 1998 | A |
5769855 | Bertin et al. | Jun 1998 | A |
5769899 | Schwartz | Jun 1998 | A |
5772594 | Barrick | Jun 1998 | A |
5776136 | Sahay et al. | Jul 1998 | A |
5776200 | Johnson | Jul 1998 | A |
5776201 | Colleran et al. | Jul 1998 | A |
5782925 | Collazo et al. | Jul 1998 | A |
5788700 | Morawa et al. | Aug 1998 | A |
5792135 | Madhani et al. | Aug 1998 | A |
5792139 | Chambers | Aug 1998 | A |
5792147 | Evans et al. | Aug 1998 | A |
5799055 | Peshkin et al. | Aug 1998 | A |
5806518 | Mittelstadt | Sep 1998 | A |
5807377 | Madhani et al. | Sep 1998 | A |
5810827 | Haines | Sep 1998 | A |
5810829 | Elliott et al. | Sep 1998 | A |
5815640 | Wang et al. | Sep 1998 | A |
5817105 | Van Der Brug | Oct 1998 | A |
5817109 | McGarry | Oct 1998 | A |
5820623 | Ng | Oct 1998 | A |
5823958 | Truppe | Oct 1998 | A |
5824085 | Sahay et al. | Oct 1998 | A |
5828770 | Leis et al. | Oct 1998 | A |
5829444 | Ferre et al. | Nov 1998 | A |
5830216 | Insall et al. | Nov 1998 | A |
5842477 | Naughton et al. | Dec 1998 | A |
5846237 | Nettekoven | Dec 1998 | A |
5846244 | Cripe | Dec 1998 | A |
5846931 | Hattersley | Dec 1998 | A |
5848967 | Cosman | Dec 1998 | A |
5851183 | Bucholz | Dec 1998 | A |
5853415 | Bertin et al. | Dec 1998 | A |
5860980 | Axelson | Jan 1999 | A |
5860981 | Bertin et al. | Jan 1999 | A |
5866415 | Villeneuve | Feb 1999 | A |
5871018 | Delp | Feb 1999 | A |
5871493 | Sjostrom | Feb 1999 | A |
5871541 | Gerber | Feb 1999 | A |
5871543 | Hofmann | Feb 1999 | A |
5879354 | Haines | Mar 1999 | A |
5880976 | DiGioia et al. | Mar 1999 | A |
5885296 | Masini | Mar 1999 | A |
5888219 | Bonutti | Mar 1999 | A |
5891157 | Day et al. | Apr 1999 | A |
5897559 | Masini | Apr 1999 | A |
5899914 | Zirps | May 1999 | A |
5899939 | Boyce et al. | May 1999 | A |
5902239 | Buurman | May 1999 | A |
5908424 | Bertin et al. | Jun 1999 | A |
5910143 | Cripe et al. | Jun 1999 | A |
5911723 | Ashby et al. | Jun 1999 | A |
5913874 | Berns | Jun 1999 | A |
5916219 | Matsuno et al. | Jun 1999 | A |
5916220 | Masini | Jun 1999 | A |
5916221 | Hodorek | Jun 1999 | A |
5916269 | Serbousek et al. | Jun 1999 | A |
5921986 | Bonutti | Jul 1999 | A |
5921990 | Webb | Jul 1999 | A |
5921992 | Costales et al. | Jul 1999 | A |
5925049 | Gustilo et al. | Jul 1999 | A |
5928234 | Manspeizer | Jul 1999 | A |
5931832 | Jensen | Aug 1999 | A |
5935128 | Carter et al. | Aug 1999 | A |
5935132 | Bettuchi et al. | Aug 1999 | A |
5944722 | Masini | Aug 1999 | A |
5947973 | Masini | Sep 1999 | A |
5952796 | Colgate et al. | Sep 1999 | A |
5954648 | Van Der Brug | Sep 1999 | A |
5957926 | Masini | Sep 1999 | A |
5961499 | Bonutti | Oct 1999 | A |
5961523 | Masini | Oct 1999 | A |
5967777 | Klein et al. | Oct 1999 | A |
5971976 | Wang et al. | Oct 1999 | A |
5971989 | Masini | Oct 1999 | A |
5976122 | Madhani et al. | Nov 1999 | A |
5976156 | Taylor et al. | Nov 1999 | A |
5980248 | Kusakabe et al. | Nov 1999 | A |
5980526 | Johnson et al. | Nov 1999 | A |
5980559 | Bonutti | Nov 1999 | A |
5984922 | McKay | Nov 1999 | A |
5995738 | Di Gioia et al. | Nov 1999 | A |
5997566 | Tobin | Dec 1999 | A |
5997577 | Herrington | Dec 1999 | A |
6001106 | Ryan | Dec 1999 | A |
6002859 | Di Gioia et al. | Dec 1999 | A |
6007537 | Burkinshaw | Dec 1999 | A |
6012456 | Schuerch | Jan 2000 | A |
6013081 | Burkinshaw et al. | Jan 2000 | A |
6013103 | Kaufman et al. | Jan 2000 | A |
6013853 | Athanasiou | Jan 2000 | A |
6015419 | Strome | Jan 2000 | A |
6019767 | Howell | Feb 2000 | A |
6022350 | Ganem | Feb 2000 | A |
6024746 | Katz | Feb 2000 | A |
6026315 | Lenz et al. | Feb 2000 | A |
6027504 | McGuire | Feb 2000 | A |
6033410 | McLean et al. | Mar 2000 | A |
6033415 | Mittelstadt et al. | Mar 2000 | A |
6034296 | Elvin | Mar 2000 | A |
6036696 | Lambrecht | Mar 2000 | A |
6037927 | Rosenberg | Mar 2000 | A |
6038467 | De Bliek et al. | Mar 2000 | A |
6056754 | Haines | May 2000 | A |
6059788 | Katz | May 2000 | A |
6059817 | Bonutti et al. | May 2000 | A |
6059831 | Braslow et al. | May 2000 | A |
6063095 | Wang et al. | May 2000 | A |
6068633 | Masini | May 2000 | A |
6068658 | Insall | May 2000 | A |
6077269 | Masini | Jun 2000 | A |
6077270 | Katz | Jun 2000 | A |
6077287 | Taylor | Jun 2000 | A |
6086593 | Bonutti | Jul 2000 | A |
6090114 | Matsuno et al. | Jul 2000 | A |
6090122 | Sjostrom | Jul 2000 | A |
6099531 | Bonutti | Aug 2000 | A |
6099532 | Florea | Aug 2000 | A |
6102850 | Wang et al. | Aug 2000 | A |
6102916 | Masini | Aug 2000 | A |
6102954 | Albrecktsson | Aug 2000 | A |
6102955 | Mendes et al. | Aug 2000 | A |
6106464 | Bass et al. | Aug 2000 | A |
6106529 | Techiera | Aug 2000 | A |
6110188 | Narciso | Aug 2000 | A |
6112113 | Van Der Brug et al. | Aug 2000 | A |
6118845 | Simon et al. | Sep 2000 | A |
6122538 | Sliwa, Jr. et al. | Sep 2000 | A |
6132468 | Mansmann | Oct 2000 | A |
6146385 | Torrie | Nov 2000 | A |
6159246 | Mendes et al. | Dec 2000 | A |
6161033 | Kuhn | Dec 2000 | A |
6165223 | Metzger | Dec 2000 | A |
6167292 | Badano et al. | Dec 2000 | A |
6167295 | Cosman | Dec 2000 | A |
6167296 | Shahidi | Dec 2000 | A |
6171340 | McDowell | Jan 2001 | B1 |
6174314 | Waddell | Jan 2001 | B1 |
6174321 | Webb | Jan 2001 | B1 |
6176880 | Plouhar | Jan 2001 | B1 |
6185315 | Schmucker et al. | Feb 2001 | B1 |
6187010 | Masini | Feb 2001 | B1 |
6187023 | Bonutti | Feb 2001 | B1 |
6190390 | McAllister | Feb 2001 | B1 |
6193723 | Cripe et al. | Feb 2001 | B1 |
6195167 | Reid et al. | Feb 2001 | B1 |
6195168 | De Lega et al. | Feb 2001 | B1 |
6197064 | Haines et al. | Mar 2001 | B1 |
6198794 | Peshkin et al. | Mar 2001 | B1 |
6205411 | DiGioia et al. | Mar 2001 | B1 |
6206927 | Fell et al. | Mar 2001 | B1 |
6211976 | Popovich et al. | Apr 2001 | B1 |
6214011 | Masini | Apr 2001 | B1 |
6214018 | Kreizman et al. | Apr 2001 | B1 |
6214051 | Badorf | Apr 2001 | B1 |
6226543 | Gilboa et al. | May 2001 | B1 |
6226548 | Foley et al. | May 2001 | B1 |
6228089 | Wahrburg | May 2001 | B1 |
6228090 | Waddell | May 2001 | B1 |
6228091 | Lombardo et al. | May 2001 | B1 |
6228121 | Khalili | May 2001 | B1 |
6233504 | Das et al. | May 2001 | B1 |
6235038 | Hunter et al. | May 2001 | B1 |
6236875 | Bucholz et al. | May 2001 | B1 |
6236906 | Muller | May 2001 | B1 |
6241657 | Chen et al. | Jun 2001 | B1 |
6241735 | Marmulla | Jun 2001 | B1 |
6246200 | Blumenkranz et al. | Jun 2001 | B1 |
6246898 | Vesely et al. | Jun 2001 | B1 |
6253100 | Zhdanov | Jun 2001 | B1 |
6258095 | Lombardo | Jul 2001 | B1 |
6258104 | Kreizman et al. | Jul 2001 | B1 |
6258127 | Schmotzer | Jul 2001 | B1 |
6264701 | Brekke | Jul 2001 | B1 |
6273896 | Franck et al. | Aug 2001 | B1 |
6277136 | Bonutti | Aug 2001 | B1 |
6280476 | Metzger et al. | Aug 2001 | B1 |
6285902 | Kienzle et al. | Sep 2001 | B1 |
6290703 | Ganem | Sep 2001 | B1 |
6296646 | Williamson | Oct 2001 | B1 |
6299645 | Ogden et al. | Oct 2001 | B1 |
6304050 | Skaar et al. | Oct 2001 | B1 |
6306169 | Lee et al. | Oct 2001 | B1 |
6306172 | O'Neil | Oct 2001 | B1 |
6314312 | Wessels et al. | Nov 2001 | B1 |
6319283 | Insall | Nov 2001 | B1 |
6322567 | Mittelstadt et al. | Nov 2001 | B1 |
6325806 | Fox | Dec 2001 | B1 |
6325828 | Dennis | Dec 2001 | B1 |
6328572 | Higashida | Dec 2001 | B1 |
6336931 | Hsu et al. | Jan 2002 | B1 |
6338730 | Bonutti et al. | Jan 2002 | B1 |
6338737 | Toledano | Jan 2002 | B1 |
6341231 | Ferre et al. | Jan 2002 | B1 |
6342075 | MacArthur | Jan 2002 | B1 |
6347240 | Foley et al. | Feb 2002 | B1 |
6351659 | Vilsmeier | Feb 2002 | B1 |
6351661 | Cosman | Feb 2002 | B1 |
6352558 | Spector | Mar 2002 | B1 |
6358266 | Bonutti | Mar 2002 | B1 |
6361565 | Bonutti | Mar 2002 | B1 |
6379387 | Tornier | Apr 2002 | B1 |
6385475 | Cinquin et al. | May 2002 | B1 |
6385509 | Das et al. | May 2002 | B2 |
6391040 | Christodias | May 2002 | B1 |
6398815 | Pope et al. | Jun 2002 | B1 |
6406495 | Schoch | Jun 2002 | B1 |
6409722 | Hoey | Jun 2002 | B1 |
6409731 | Masson et al. | Jun 2002 | B1 |
6413261 | Grundei | Jul 2002 | B1 |
6413279 | Metzger | Jul 2002 | B1 |
6419704 | Ferree | Jul 2002 | B1 |
6423063 | Bonutti | Jul 2002 | B1 |
6423096 | Musset et al. | Jul 2002 | B1 |
6430434 | Mittelstadt | Aug 2002 | B1 |
6431743 | Mizutani | Aug 2002 | B1 |
6434415 | Foley et al. | Aug 2002 | B1 |
6440444 | Boyce et al. | Aug 2002 | B2 |
D462767 | Meyer | Sep 2002 | S |
6443991 | Running | Sep 2002 | B1 |
6450978 | Brosseau et al. | Sep 2002 | B1 |
6466815 | Saito et al. | Oct 2002 | B1 |
6468280 | Saenger et al. | Oct 2002 | B1 |
6468289 | Bonutti | Oct 2002 | B1 |
6473635 | Rasche | Oct 2002 | B1 |
6478799 | Williamson | Nov 2002 | B1 |
6482209 | Engh et al. | Nov 2002 | B1 |
6488687 | Masini | Dec 2002 | B1 |
6490467 | Bucholz et al. | Dec 2002 | B1 |
6491702 | Heilbrun et al. | Dec 2002 | B2 |
6491726 | Pappas | Dec 2002 | B2 |
6494914 | Brown et al. | Dec 2002 | B2 |
6500179 | Masini | Dec 2002 | B1 |
6500181 | Portney | Dec 2002 | B1 |
6503267 | Bonutti et al. | Jan 2003 | B2 |
6503277 | Bonutti | Jan 2003 | B2 |
6514259 | Picard et al. | Feb 2003 | B2 |
6522906 | Salisbury | Feb 2003 | B1 |
6527443 | Vilsmeier et al. | Mar 2003 | B1 |
6533737 | Brosseau et al. | Mar 2003 | B1 |
6540786 | Chibrac | Apr 2003 | B2 |
6551324 | Muller | Apr 2003 | B2 |
6551325 | Neubauer et al. | Apr 2003 | B2 |
6554838 | McGovern | Apr 2003 | B2 |
6558391 | Axelson | May 2003 | B2 |
6558421 | Fell | May 2003 | B1 |
6575980 | Robie | Jun 2003 | B1 |
6575982 | Bonutti | Jun 2003 | B1 |
6584339 | Galloway, Jr. et al. | Jun 2003 | B2 |
6585651 | Nolte et al. | Jul 2003 | B2 |
6589248 | Hughes | Jul 2003 | B1 |
6589281 | Hyde | Jul 2003 | B2 |
6589283 | Metzger | Jul 2003 | B1 |
6611141 | Schulz et al. | Aug 2003 | B1 |
6616696 | Merchant | Sep 2003 | B1 |
6620181 | Bonutti | Sep 2003 | B1 |
6623526 | Lloyd | Sep 2003 | B1 |
6629997 | Mansmann | Oct 2003 | B2 |
6632225 | Sanford et al. | Oct 2003 | B2 |
6635073 | Bonutti | Oct 2003 | B2 |
6638279 | Bonutti | Oct 2003 | B2 |
6645215 | McGovern et al. | Nov 2003 | B1 |
6648896 | Overes | Nov 2003 | B2 |
6652532 | Bonutti | Nov 2003 | B2 |
6652587 | Felt | Nov 2003 | B2 |
6660040 | Cahn et al. | Dec 2003 | B2 |
6672039 | Shonnard | Jan 2004 | B1 |
6685711 | Axelson, Jr. et al. | Feb 2004 | B2 |
6695848 | Haines | Feb 2004 | B2 |
6697664 | Kienzie | Feb 2004 | B2 |
6702821 | Bonutti | Mar 2004 | B2 |
6709460 | Merchant | Mar 2004 | B2 |
6711431 | Sarin et al. | Mar 2004 | B2 |
6712824 | Millard et al. | Mar 2004 | B2 |
6723102 | Johnson et al. | Apr 2004 | B2 |
6733533 | Lozier | May 2004 | B1 |
6740092 | Lombardo et al. | May 2004 | B2 |
6743258 | Keller | Jun 2004 | B1 |
6749638 | Saladino | Jun 2004 | B1 |
6755865 | Tarabishy | Jun 2004 | B2 |
6757582 | Brisson et al. | Jun 2004 | B2 |
6770077 | Van Zile et al. | Aug 2004 | B2 |
6770078 | Bonutti | Aug 2004 | B2 |
6772053 | Niemeyer | Aug 2004 | B2 |
6782287 | Grzeszczuk et al. | Aug 2004 | B2 |
6785572 | Yanof et al. | Aug 2004 | B2 |
6793676 | Plouhar | Sep 2004 | B2 |
6796986 | Duffner | Sep 2004 | B2 |
6827723 | Carson | Dec 2004 | B2 |
6858032 | Chow et al. | Feb 2005 | B2 |
6859660 | Vilsmeier | Feb 2005 | B2 |
6859661 | Tuke | Feb 2005 | B2 |
6895268 | Rahn et al. | May 2005 | B1 |
6916341 | Rolston | Jul 2005 | B2 |
6917827 | Kienzle | Jul 2005 | B2 |
6923817 | Carson et al. | Aug 2005 | B2 |
6966928 | Fell | Nov 2005 | B2 |
6969393 | Pinczewski | Nov 2005 | B2 |
6972039 | Metzger | Dec 2005 | B2 |
6986791 | Metzger | Jan 2006 | B1 |
6994730 | Posner | Feb 2006 | B2 |
7029477 | Grimm | Apr 2006 | B2 |
7033361 | Collazo | Apr 2006 | B2 |
7035716 | Harris et al. | Apr 2006 | B2 |
7048741 | Swanson | May 2006 | B2 |
7060074 | Rosa | Jun 2006 | B2 |
7070557 | Bonutti | Jul 2006 | B2 |
7083624 | Irving | Aug 2006 | B2 |
7087073 | Bonutti | Aug 2006 | B2 |
7094241 | Hodorek | Aug 2006 | B2 |
7104996 | Bonutti | Sep 2006 | B2 |
7104997 | Lionberger et al. | Sep 2006 | B2 |
7105027 | Lipman | Sep 2006 | B2 |
7128745 | Masini | Oct 2006 | B2 |
7141053 | Rosa et al. | Nov 2006 | B2 |
7172596 | Coon et al. | Feb 2007 | B2 |
7175597 | Vince | Feb 2007 | B2 |
7206626 | Quaid, III | Apr 2007 | B2 |
7206627 | Abovitz et al. | Apr 2007 | B2 |
7220264 | Hershberger | May 2007 | B1 |
7241298 | Nemec et al. | Jul 2007 | B2 |
7244274 | Delfosse | Jul 2007 | B2 |
7285122 | Sanford et al. | Oct 2007 | B2 |
7302288 | Schellenberg | Nov 2007 | B1 |
7309339 | Cusick et al. | Dec 2007 | B2 |
7329260 | Auger et al. | Feb 2008 | B2 |
7335206 | Steffensmeier | Feb 2008 | B2 |
7344542 | Collazo et al. | Mar 2008 | B2 |
7346417 | Luth et al. | Mar 2008 | B2 |
7364581 | Michalowicz | Apr 2008 | B2 |
7371240 | Pinczewski | May 2008 | B2 |
7374563 | Roger et al. | May 2008 | B2 |
7377924 | Raistrick et al. | May 2008 | B2 |
7422605 | Burstein | Sep 2008 | B2 |
7510557 | Bonutti | Mar 2009 | B1 |
7520880 | Claypool et al. | Apr 2009 | B2 |
7527630 | Faoro et al. | May 2009 | B2 |
7547307 | Carson et al. | Jun 2009 | B2 |
7569060 | Faoro | Aug 2009 | B2 |
7572262 | Hoeppner et al. | Aug 2009 | B1 |
7599730 | Hunter et al. | Oct 2009 | B2 |
7615054 | Bonutti | Nov 2009 | B1 |
7618421 | Axelson, Jr. et al. | Nov 2009 | B2 |
7635390 | Bonutti | Dec 2009 | B1 |
7666187 | Axelson, Jr. et al. | Feb 2010 | B2 |
7674268 | Cuckler et al. | Mar 2010 | B2 |
7678115 | D'Alessio, II et al. | Mar 2010 | B2 |
7686812 | Axelson, Jr. et al. | Mar 2010 | B2 |
7708740 | Bonutti | May 2010 | B1 |
7708741 | Bonutti | May 2010 | B1 |
7727239 | Justin et al. | Jun 2010 | B2 |
7744601 | Rosa et al. | Jun 2010 | B2 |
7747311 | Quaid | Jun 2010 | B2 |
7749229 | Bonutti | Jul 2010 | B1 |
7763027 | Irving | Jul 2010 | B2 |
7766913 | Bennett et al. | Aug 2010 | B2 |
7780671 | Berger et al. | Aug 2010 | B2 |
7789885 | Metzger | Sep 2010 | B2 |
7799084 | Clemow et al. | Sep 2010 | B2 |
7806896 | Bonutti | Oct 2010 | B1 |
7806897 | Bonutti | Oct 2010 | B1 |
7815645 | Haines | Oct 2010 | B2 |
7828852 | Bonutti | Nov 2010 | B2 |
7837736 | Bonutti | Nov 2010 | B2 |
7842039 | Hodorek et al. | Nov 2010 | B2 |
7857814 | Haines | Dec 2010 | B2 |
7887542 | Metzger et al. | Feb 2011 | B2 |
7892236 | Bonutti | Feb 2011 | B1 |
7896880 | Bonutti | Mar 2011 | B2 |
7909831 | Axelson, Jr. et al. | Mar 2011 | B2 |
7931655 | Axelson, Jr. et al. | Apr 2011 | B2 |
7931690 | Bonutti | Apr 2011 | B1 |
7935120 | Griner et al. | May 2011 | B2 |
7942882 | Tornier et al. | May 2011 | B2 |
7959635 | Bonutti | Jun 2011 | B1 |
7959637 | Fox et al. | Jun 2011 | B2 |
7963968 | Dees, Jr. | Jun 2011 | B2 |
7985226 | McAllister et al. | Jul 2011 | B2 |
7993341 | Grimm et al. | Aug 2011 | B2 |
8021368 | Haines | Sep 2011 | B2 |
8029508 | Cuckler et al. | Oct 2011 | B2 |
8043292 | Carusillo | Oct 2011 | B2 |
8052692 | Lionberger et al. | Nov 2011 | B2 |
8070752 | Metzger et al. | Dec 2011 | B2 |
8092462 | Pinczewski | Jan 2012 | B2 |
8092465 | Metzger et al. | Jan 2012 | B2 |
8095200 | Quaid, III | Jan 2012 | B2 |
8114086 | Claypool et al. | Feb 2012 | B2 |
8118811 | Coon et al. | Feb 2012 | B2 |
8133229 | Bonutti | Mar 2012 | B1 |
8147496 | Couture et al. | Apr 2012 | B2 |
8147514 | Bonutti | Apr 2012 | B2 |
8160345 | Pavlovskaia et al. | Apr 2012 | B2 |
8167888 | Steffensmeier | May 2012 | B2 |
8236000 | Ammann et al. | Aug 2012 | B2 |
8241292 | Collazo | Aug 2012 | B2 |
8246626 | Cuckler et al. | Aug 2012 | B2 |
8257360 | Richard et al. | Sep 2012 | B2 |
8277455 | Couture et al. | Oct 2012 | B2 |
8287545 | Haines | Oct 2012 | B2 |
8317797 | Rasmussen | Nov 2012 | B2 |
8323287 | Pinczewski et al. | Dec 2012 | B2 |
8323288 | Zajac | Dec 2012 | B2 |
8333772 | Fox et al. | Dec 2012 | B2 |
8357111 | Caillouette et al. | Jan 2013 | B2 |
8357166 | Aram et al. | Jan 2013 | B2 |
8372078 | Collazo | Feb 2013 | B2 |
8377066 | Katrana et al. | Feb 2013 | B2 |
8377068 | Aker et al. | Feb 2013 | B2 |
8377069 | D'Alessio, II et al. | Feb 2013 | B2 |
8377129 | Fitz et al. | Feb 2013 | B2 |
8377141 | McMinn | Feb 2013 | B2 |
8398645 | Aker et al. | Mar 2013 | B2 |
8425522 | Bonutti | Apr 2013 | B2 |
8425523 | Aram et al. | Apr 2013 | B2 |
8425524 | Aker et al. | Apr 2013 | B2 |
8435246 | Fisher et al. | May 2013 | B2 |
8454616 | Hodorek et al. | Jun 2013 | B2 |
8623030 | Bonutti | Jan 2014 | B2 |
8632552 | Bonutti | Jan 2014 | B2 |
8641726 | Bonutti | Feb 2014 | B2 |
8834490 | Bonutti | Sep 2014 | B2 |
8840629 | Bonutti | Sep 2014 | B2 |
8858557 | Bonutti | Oct 2014 | B2 |
20010018589 | Muller | Aug 2001 | A1 |
20010023371 | Bonutti | Sep 2001 | A1 |
20010027272 | Saito et al. | Oct 2001 | A1 |
20010029333 | Shahidi | Oct 2001 | A1 |
20010034554 | Pappas | Oct 2001 | A1 |
20010037155 | Merchant | Nov 2001 | A1 |
20020029038 | Haines | Mar 2002 | A1 |
20020038085 | Immerz | Mar 2002 | A1 |
20020055755 | Bonutti | May 2002 | A1 |
20020077543 | Grzeszczuk et al. | Jun 2002 | A1 |
20020127264 | Felt | Sep 2002 | A1 |
20020133162 | Axelson et al. | Sep 2002 | A1 |
20020133175 | Carson | Sep 2002 | A1 |
20020138150 | Leclercq | Sep 2002 | A1 |
20020147455 | Carson | Oct 2002 | A1 |
20020173797 | Van Zile | Nov 2002 | A1 |
20020183608 | Marmulla et al. | Dec 2002 | A1 |
20020198528 | Engh | Dec 2002 | A1 |
20020198530 | Sanford | Dec 2002 | A1 |
20030045883 | Chow | Mar 2003 | A1 |
20030059097 | Abovitz et al. | Mar 2003 | A1 |
20030074011 | Gilboa et al. | Apr 2003 | A1 |
20030093079 | Masini | May 2003 | A1 |
20030100906 | Rosa | May 2003 | A1 |
20030100907 | Rosa | May 2003 | A1 |
20030130665 | Pinczewshi | Jul 2003 | A1 |
20030153923 | Pinczewshi | Aug 2003 | A1 |
20030158606 | Coon | Aug 2003 | A1 |
20030163137 | Smucker | Aug 2003 | A1 |
20030164172 | Chumas et al. | Sep 2003 | A1 |
20030171757 | Coon | Sep 2003 | A1 |
20030181984 | Abendschein | Sep 2003 | A1 |
20030212403 | Swanson | Nov 2003 | A1 |
20030220697 | Justin | Nov 2003 | A1 |
20030225458 | Donkers | Dec 2003 | A1 |
20030236523 | Johnson | Dec 2003 | A1 |
20040010190 | Shahidi | Jan 2004 | A1 |
20040024311 | Quaid, III | Feb 2004 | A1 |
20040034283 | Quaid, III | Feb 2004 | A1 |
20040034302 | Abovitz et al. | Feb 2004 | A1 |
20040039395 | Coon | Feb 2004 | A1 |
20040039396 | Couture et al. | Feb 2004 | A1 |
20040039450 | Griner et al. | Feb 2004 | A1 |
20040077939 | Graumann | Apr 2004 | A1 |
20040102851 | Saladino | May 2004 | A1 |
20040106916 | Quaid et al. | Jun 2004 | A1 |
20040143338 | Burkinshaw | Jul 2004 | A1 |
20040149036 | Foxlin et al. | Aug 2004 | A1 |
20040204760 | Fita | Oct 2004 | A1 |
20040210125 | Chen et al. | Oct 2004 | A1 |
20040249387 | Faoro | Dec 2004 | A1 |
20040260301 | Lionberger | Dec 2004 | A1 |
20050027186 | Chen et al. | Feb 2005 | A1 |
20050043807 | Wood | Feb 2005 | A1 |
20050055028 | Haines | Mar 2005 | A1 |
20050080424 | Cuckler et al. | Apr 2005 | A1 |
20050171545 | Walsh et al. | Aug 2005 | A1 |
20050234465 | McCombs et al. | Oct 2005 | A1 |
20050273115 | Coon et al. | Dec 2005 | A1 |
20050277832 | Foley et al. | Dec 2005 | A1 |
20060025681 | Abovitz et al. | Feb 2006 | A1 |
20060030854 | Haines | Feb 2006 | A1 |
20060122617 | Lavallee et al. | Jun 2006 | A1 |
20060149276 | Grimm | Jul 2006 | A1 |
20060155291 | Farrar et al. | Jul 2006 | A1 |
20060155294 | Steffensmeier et al. | Jul 2006 | A1 |
20060167483 | Asculai et al. | Jul 2006 | A1 |
20060195111 | Couture | Aug 2006 | A1 |
20060241636 | Novak et al. | Oct 2006 | A1 |
20070233137 | Seo et al. | Oct 2007 | A1 |
20070233138 | Figueroa et al. | Oct 2007 | A1 |
20080015605 | Collazo | Jan 2008 | A1 |
20080015607 | D'Alessio et al. | Jan 2008 | A1 |
20080147075 | Bonutti | Jun 2008 | A1 |
20080172054 | Claypool et al. | Jul 2008 | A1 |
20080195109 | Hunter et al. | Aug 2008 | A1 |
20080234692 | Brandt et al. | Sep 2008 | A1 |
20080262500 | Collazo | Oct 2008 | A1 |
20100010493 | Dower | Jan 2010 | A1 |
20100023015 | Park | Jan 2010 | A1 |
20100191244 | White et al. | Jul 2010 | A1 |
20100217338 | Carroll et al. | Aug 2010 | A1 |
20100312350 | Bonutti | Dec 2010 | A1 |
20110166578 | Stone et al. | Jul 2011 | A1 |
20110172672 | Dubeau et al. | Jul 2011 | A1 |
20120010623 | Bonutti | Jan 2012 | A1 |
20120053591 | Haines et al. | Mar 2012 | A1 |
20120071883 | Lang et al. | Mar 2012 | A1 |
20120078262 | Pinczewski et al. | Mar 2012 | A1 |
20120109152 | Quaid | May 2012 | A1 |
20120158001 | Burdulis et al. | Jun 2012 | A1 |
20120215226 | Bonutti | Aug 2012 | A1 |
20120221017 | Bonutti | Aug 2012 | A1 |
20120316563 | Metzger et al. | Dec 2012 | A1 |
20130006251 | Aram et al. | Jan 2013 | A1 |
20130060253 | Couture et al. | Mar 2013 | A1 |
20130123789 | Park | May 2013 | A1 |
20130131681 | Katrana et al. | May 2013 | A1 |
20130197543 | Bonutti | Aug 2013 | A1 |
20130226185 | Bonutti | Aug 2013 | A1 |
20130237989 | Bonutti | Sep 2013 | A1 |
20130289729 | Bonutti | Oct 2013 | A1 |
20140058393 | Bonutti | Feb 2014 | A1 |
20140058408 | Bonutti | Feb 2014 | A1 |
20140088598 | Bonutti | Mar 2014 | A1 |
20140343573 | Bonutti | Nov 2014 | A1 |
Number | Date | Country |
---|---|---|
663893 | Jan 1988 | CH |
0663893 | Jan 1988 | CH |
3429157 | Feb 1986 | DE |
4011216 | May 1991 | DE |
4242889 | Jun 1994 | DE |
19544084 | May 1997 | DE |
19746613 | Sep 1999 | DE |
19954005 | Jun 2001 | DE |
0336774 | Apr 1989 | EP |
0502738 | May 1992 | EP |
0520737 | Sep 1992 | EP |
1051954 | Nov 2000 | EP |
1099430 | May 2001 | EP |
1245204 | Feb 2002 | EP |
1260183 | Nov 2002 | EP |
1317911 | Jun 2003 | EP |
2266492 | Oct 1975 | FR |
2595241 | Sep 1987 | FR |
2625096 | Jun 1989 | FR |
2660546 | Oct 1991 | FR |
2682287 | Apr 1993 | FR |
2768329 | Mar 1999 | FR |
200219296 | Jan 2002 | JP |
2002291779 | Oct 2002 | JP |
2003159439 | Jun 2003 | JP |
719625 | Mar 1980 | RU |
757159 | Aug 1980 | RU |
719625 | Mar 1980 | SU |
757159 | Aug 1980 | SU |
9325157 | Jun 1993 | WO |
WO 9325157 | Jun 1993 | WO |
9514444 | Jun 1995 | WO |
9611624 | Apr 1996 | WO |
WO9611624 | Apr 1996 | WO |
PCTUS9702327 | Feb 1997 | WO |
PCTUS9702520 | Feb 1997 | WO |
9725006 | Jul 1997 | WO |
9729703 | Aug 1997 | WO |
9729704 | Aug 1997 | WO |
9740763 | Nov 1997 | WO |
WO9740763 | Nov 1997 | WO |
9832384 | Jul 1998 | WO |
9913803 | Mar 1999 | WO |
9920184 | Apr 1999 | WO |
9940864 | Aug 1999 | WO |
0217821 | Aug 2000 | WO |
0166022 | Sep 2001 | WO |
0200131 | Mar 2002 | WO |
WO0200131 | Mar 2002 | WO |
02067783 | Sep 2002 | WO |
02067784 | Sep 2002 | WO |
Entry |
---|
G. Aldinger, Computer-aided Manufacture of Individual Endoprostheses, Arch Orthop Trauma Surg (1983) 102: 31-35. |
K. R. Berend, Mobile-bearing Unicompartmental Knee Arthroplasty (UKA), Featured Article. |
R. A. Berger, Unicompartmental Knee Arthroplasty, Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, No. 367, pp. 50-60, 1999. |
S. Bernardino, Total elbow arthroplasty: history, current concepts, and future, Clinical Rheumatology , 2010. |
T. L. Bernasek, Unicompartmental Porous Coated Anatomic Total Knee Arthroplasty, 1988. |
J. M. Bert, Universal Intramedullary Instrumentation for Unicompartmental Total Knee Arthroplasty, Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, No. 271, 1991. |
P.M. Bonutti, Scientific evidence for the use of modern unicompartmental knee arthroplasty, Expert Review of Medical Devices. 7.2, pp. 219, 2010. |
J. A. Epinette, Hydroxyapatite-Coated Unicompartmental Knee Replacement, Unicompartmental Knee Arthroplasty, 1997. |
M. Fadda, Computer Assisted Planning for Total Knee Arthroplasty, 1997. |
J. N. Insall, Surgery of the Knee—Second Edition, Churchill Livingstone Inc, 1993. |
T. C. Kienzle, A Computer-Assisted Total Knee Replacement Surgical System Using a Calibrated Robot, 1996. |
M. Marcacci, Computer- Assisted Knee Arthroplasty, 1996. |
Ph. Hernigou, M.D., Unicompartmental Knee, 1997. |
F. F. Buechel, “Floating-Socket” Total Shoulder Replacement: Anatomical, Biomechanical, and Surgical Rationale, John Wiley & Sons, Inc., 1978. |
F. F. Buechel, The New Jersey Low-Contact Stress Knee Replacement System: Biomechanical Rationale and Review of the First 123 Cemented Cases, Archives of Orthopaedic and Traumatic Surgery, 1986. |
F. F. Buechel, Mobile-Bearing Kneee Arthroplasty, The Journal of Arthroplasty vol. 19 No. 4 Suppl. 1, 2004. |
H. E. Cates, Intramedullary Versus Extramedullary Femoral Alignment Systems in Total Knee Replacement, Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, No. 286, 1993. |
B. L. Davies, ACROBOT—Using Robots and Surgeons Synergisitically in Knee Surgery, ICAR' 97, Jul. 7-9, 1997. |
S.L. Delp, Computer Assisted Knee Replacement, Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, No. 354, pp. 49-56, 1998. |
D. A. Dennis, Intramedullary Versus Extramedullary Tibial Alignment Systems in Total Knee Arthroplasty, The Journal of Arthroplasty vol. 8 No. 1, 1993. |
G. A. Engh, Comparative Experience With Intramedullary and Extramedullary Alignment in Total Knee Arthroplasty, 1990. |
J. Goodfellow, The Mechanics of the Knee and Prosthesis Design, The Journal of Bone and Joint Surgery, 1978. |
J.W. Goodfellow, Unicompartmental Oxford Meniscal Knee Arthroplasty, 1987. |
S. B. Haas, Minimally Invasive Total Knee Replacement through a Mini Midvastus Approach, Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, No. 428, 99 68-73, 2004. |
S. J. Harris, Experiences with Robotic Systems for Knee Surgery, 1997. |
T. J. Heyse, Lateral unicompartmental knee arthroplasty: a review, Arch Orthop Trauma Surg 130: 1539-1548, 2010. |
G. A. Horton, Femoral Pulse as a Guide to the Mechanical Axis in Total Knee Arthroplasty, The Journal of Arthroplasty vol. 10 No. 6, 1995. |
(K060017) MAKO Surgical Corp., Knee joint femorotibial metal/polymer non-constrained cemented prosthesis, 2006. |
(K072806) MAKO Surgical Corp., Tactile Guidance System (TGS), 2008. |
(K091263) Zimmer Patient Specific Instruments, 2009. |
T. C. Kienzle, An Integrated CAD-Robotics System for Total Knee Replacement Surgery, 1992. |
J. T. Lea, Registration and immobilization in robot-assisted surgery, Journal of Image Guided Surgery pp. 80-87, 1995. |
D. L. MacIntosh, Joint Meeting of the Orthopaedic Associations of the English-Speaking World, The Journal of Bone and Joint Surgery, 1958. |
M. Marcacci, A Navigation Sytem for Computer Assisted Unicompartmental Arthroplasty, Springer-Verlag Berlin Heidelberg, 2000. |
M. Martelli, Computer- and Robot-Assisted Total Knee Replacement: Analysis of a New Surgical Procedure, Annals of Biomedical Engineering, vol. 28, pp. 1146-1153, 2000. |
(P010014) Department of Health & Human Services, 2004. |
(P010014A )Department of Health & Human Services, 2004. |
P. F. La Palombara, Minimally invasive 3D data registration in computer and robot assisted total knee arthroplasty, Medical & Biological Engineering & Computing, 1997. |
M. Peshkin, Total Knee Replacement, IEEE Engineering in Medicine and Biology, 1995. |
K. Radermacher, Computer Assisted Orthopaedic Surgery with Image Based Individual Templates, Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research No. 354, pp. 28-38, 1998. |
L. Regner, Ceramic Coating Improves Tibial Component Fixation in Total Knee Arthroplasty, Churchill Livingstone, 1998. |
J. A. Repicci, Minimally Invasive Surgical Technique for Unicondylar Knee Arthroplasty, Journal of the Southern Orthopaedic Association vol. 8 No. 1, 1999. |
M. Roth, A New Less Invasive Approach to Knee Surgery Using a Vision-Guided Manipulator, 1996. |
B. Saccomanni, Unicompartmental knee arthroplasty: a review of literature, Clinical Rheumatology, 2010. |
K. P. Sherman, Bilateral Oxford Meniscal Knee arthroplasty, Journal of the Royal Society of Medicine, vol. 78, 1985. |
R. A. Siston, Surgical navigation for total knee arthroplasty: A perspective, Journal of Biomechanics pp. 728-735, 2007. |
S. D. Stulberg, Computer-Assisted Total Knee Replacement Arthoplasty, Operative Techniques in Orthopaedics, vol. 10, No. 1, pp. 25-39, 2000. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Request for Continued Examination (RCE) filed Jun. 15, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/684,103, Response to Office Action filed Apr. 23, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/684,178, Final Rejection mailed Jun. 10, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/928,898, Response to Office Action filed Jun. 18, 2010. |
A Safe Robot System for Craniofacial Surgery, D. Engel, J. Raczkowsky, H. Worn, May 21-26, 2001, Proceedings of the 2001 IEEE, International Conference on Robotics and Automation, pp. 2020-2024, 5 pages. |
A Computer and Robotic Aided Surgery System for Accomplishing Osteotomies, J. L. Moctezuma, F. Gosse, H.J. Schultz, First International Symposium on Medical Robotics and Computer Assisted Surgery, Sep. 1994, pp. 31-35, 6 pages. |
A Constraint-Based God-object Method for Haptic Display, C.B. Zilles and J. K. Salisbury, 1995 IEEE, pp. 146-151, 6 pages. |
A Literature Review: Robots in Medicine, Hsia, T.C.; Mittelstadt, B., Jun. 1991, vol. 10, Issue 2, pp. 13-22, 10 pages. |
A Novel Approach to Computer Assisted Spine Surgery, Lutz P. Nolte, Lucia J. Zamorano, Zhaowel Jlang, Qinghai Wang, Frank Langlotz, Erich Arm, Heiko Visarius, Proceedings of the First International Symposium on Medical Robotics and Computer Assisted Surgery, vol. 2, Workshop [Part I & II] Session VI, Sep. 1994, pp. 323-328, 7 pages. |
A review of robotics in surgery, B. Davies, Proceedings of the Institution of Mechanical Engineers, Part H: Journal of Engineering in Medicine, 2000, pp. 129-140, 13 pages. |
A Robotized Surgeon Assistant, T. Wang, M. Fadda, M. Marcacci, S. Martelli, P. Dario and A. Visani, pp. 852-868, 8 pages. |
A Steady-Hand Robotic System for Microsurgical Augmentation, Russell Taylor, Pat Jensen, Louis Whitcomb, Aaron Barnes, Rajest Kumar, Dan Stoianovici, Puneet Gupta, Zhengxian Wange, Eugen Dejuan and Louis Kavoussi, The International Journal of Robotics Research, 1999, vol. 18, pp. 1201-1210, 11 pages. |
A Stereotactic/Robotic System for Pedicle Screw Placement, Julio J. Santos-Munné, Michael A. Peshkin, Srdjan Mirkovic, S. David Stulberg, Thomas C. Kienzle III, 1995, Interactive Technology and the New Paradigm for Hardware, pp. 326-333, 8 pages. |
A Surgical Robot for Total Hip Replacement Surgery, Proceedings of the 1992 IEEE, International Conference on Robotics and Automation, May 1992, pp. 606-611, 6 pages. |
Accuracy Study on the Registration of the Tibia by Means of an Intramedullary Rod in Robot-Assisted Total Knee Arthroplasty, G. Van Ham, J. Bellemans, K. Denis, L. Labey, J. Vander Sloten, R. Van Audekercke, G. Van Der Perre, J. De Schutter, 46th Annual Meeting, Orthopaedic Research Society, Mar. 2000, pp. 450, 1 page. |
Accuracy Validation in Image-Guided Orthopaedic Surgery, David Simon, R.V. O'Toole, Mike Blackwell, F. Morgan, Anthony M. Digioia, and Takeo Kanade, Proceedings of the Second International Symposium on Medical Robotics and Computer Assisted Surgery, 1995, pp. 185-192, 8 pages. |
Acrobot—Using Robots and Surgeons Synergistically in Knee Surgery, BL Davies, KL Fan, RD Hibberd, M. Jakopec and SJ Harris, Mechatronics in Medicine, Jul. 1997, pp. 173-178, 6 pages. |
Active compliance in robotic surgery—the use of force control as a dynamic constraint, B.L. Davies, S. J. Harris, W. J. Lin, R. D. Hibberd, R. Middleton and J.C. Cobb, Proceedings of the Institution of Mechanical Engineers, Part H: Journal of Engineering in Medicine, 1997 vol. 211, pp. 285-292; 9 pages. |
Active Stiffness Control of a Manipulator in Cartesian Coordinates, J. Kenneth Sallsbury, IEEE, 1980, pp. 95-100, 7 pages. |
An Image-directed Robotic System for Hip Replacement Surgery, Russell H. Taylor, Howard A. Paul, Brent D. Mittelstadt, William Hanson, Peter Kazanzides, Joel Zuhars, Edward Glassman, Bela L. Musits, Bill Williamson, William L. Bargar, Oct., 1990, pp. 111-118, 7 pages. |
An Integrated CAD-Robotics System for Total Knee Replacement Surgery, Kienzle, T.C., III, 1993, IEEE, pp. 889-894, 6 pages. |
Architecture of a Surgical Robot, P. Kazanzides, J. Zuhars, B. Mittelstadt, B. Williams, P. Cain, F. Smith, L. Rose, B. Musits, 1992 IEEE, pp. 1624-1629, 6 pages. |
Autonomous Suturing using Minimally Invasive Surgerical Robots, Hyosig Kang and John T. Wen, Proceedings of the 2000 IEEE, Sep. 2000, pp. 742-747, 6 pages. |
Biomechanics for Preoperative Planning and Surgical Simulations in Orthopaedics, Robert V. O'Toole III, Branislave Jaramaz, Anthony M. Digioia III, Christopher D. Visnic and Robert H. Reid, Comput. Biol. Med., Mar. 1995, vol. 25, No. 2 pp. 183-191, 8 pages. |
Clinical Introduction of the Caspar System Problems and Initial Results, C.O.R. Grueneis, R.N. Richter, F.F. Hennig, Abstracts from CAOS, 1999, pp. 160, 1 page. |
Comparative Tracking Error Analysis of Five Different Optical Tracking Systems, R Khadem, C C Yeh, M Sadeghitehran!, M R Bax, J A Johnson, J N Welch, E P Wilkinson, R Shahidi, Computer Aided Surgery vol. 5, 2000, pp. 98-107. |
Comparison of Relative Accuracy Between a Mechanical and an Optical Position Tracker for Image-Guided Neurosurgery, Rohling R, Munger P, Hollerbach JM, Peter T., J Image Guid Surg., 1995;1(1), pp. 30-34, 4 pages. |
Computer Assisted Knee Replacement, Scott L. Delp, Ph.D., S. David Stulberg, MD, Brian Davies, Ph.D. Frederic Picard, MD and Francois Leitner, Ph.D., Clinical Orthopaedics, Sep. 1998, vol. 354, pp. 49-56; 8 pages. |
Computer Assisted Orthopaedic Surgery Image Guided and Robotic Assistive Technologies, Anthony M. Digioia, Branislav Jaramaz, and B. Colgan, Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, No. 354, Sep. 1998, pp. 8-16, 9 pages. |
Computer Assisted Planning for Total Knee Arthroplasty, CVRMed-MRCAS'97, M. Fadda, D. Bertelli, S. Martelli, M. Marcacci, P. Dario, C. Paggetti, D. Caramella, D. Tripp!, 1997, pp. 619-628, 10 pages. |
Computer Assisted Spine Surgery: a technique for accurate transpedicular screw fixation, S Lavallée, Proceedings of the First International Symposium on Medical Robotics and Computer Assisted Surgery, vol. 2, Workshop [Part I & II] Session VI, Sep. 1994, pp. 315-322, 9 pages. |
Computer-assisted and robotics surgery, Brian Davies, International Congress and Symposium Series 223, 1997, pp. 71-82; 12 pages. |
Computer-Assisted Knee Arthroplasty at Rizzoli Institutes, M. Fadda, Proceedings of the First International Symposium on Medical Robotics and Computer Assisted Surgery, Sep. 1994, pp. 26-30, 6 pages. |
Concepts and methods of registration for computer-integrated surgery, E. Bainville, I. Bricault, P. Cinquin, and S. Lavallée, Computer Assisted Orthopedic Surgery (“CAOS”), L.-P. Nolte and R. Ganz, Eds., pp. 15-34, Hogrefe & Huber, Seattle, Wash, USA, 1999; 22 pages. |
CRIGOS A Compact Robot for Image-Guided Orthopedic Surgery, Guido Brandt, Andreas Zimolong, Lional Carrat, Philippe Merloz, Hans-Walter Staudte, Stephane Lavallee, Klaus Rademacher and Gunter Rau, Dec. 1999, IEEE Transactions on Information Technology in Biomedicine, vol. 3, No. 4, pp. 252-260, 9 pages. |
Development of a Robotic Surgical Assistant, Yrjö Louhisalmi and Tatu Leinonen, 1994 IEEE, pp. 1043-1044, 2 pages. |
Development of a Surgical Robot for Cementless Total Hip Arthroplasty, Paul HA, Bargar WL, Mittlestadt B, Musits B, Taylor RH, Kazanzides P, Zuhars J, Williamson B, Hanson W. Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, Dec. 1992, pp. 57-66; 10 pages. |
Digital surgery the future of medicine and human-robot symbiotic interaction, Rony A. Abovitz, Industrial Robot: An International Journal, vol. 28, No. 5, 2001, pp. 401-405, 5 pages. |
EasyGuide Neuro, ein neues System zur bildgefuhrten Planung, Simulation und Navigation in der Neurochirurgie, TH. Schmidt and W. Hentschel, 1995, Biomedizinische Technik, Band 40, Erganzungsband 1, pp. 233-234; 2 pages. |
Ein Robotersystem für craniomaxillofaciale chirurgische Eingriffe, J. Raczkowsky, J. Münchenberg, I. Bertovic, C. Burghart, Informatik Forsch. Entw., 1999, pp. 24-35, 12 pages. |
EndoBot: A Robotic Assistant in Minimally Invasive Surgeries, Hyosig Kang and John T. Wen, IEEE, 2001, pp. 2032-2037, 6 pages. |
Experiences with Robotic Systems for Knee Surgery, S. J. Harris, W. J. Lin, K. L. Fan, R. D. Hibberd, J. Cobb, R. Middleton, B. L. Davies, CVRMed-MRCAS'97, Lecture Notes in Computer Science vol. 1205, 1997, pp. 757-766; 10 pages. |
Force Control for Robotic Surgery, S.C. Ho, R.D. Hibberd, J. Cobb and B.L. Davies, ICAR, 1995, pp. 21-32, 12 pages. |
Frameless Neuronavigation in Modern Neurosurgery, Spetzger U, Laborde G, Gilsbach JM, Minim. Invas, Neurosurg., 1995, vol. 38, pp. 163-166, 4 pages. |
Haptic information displays for computer-assisted surgery, A.E. Quaid and Rony A. Abovitz, Robotics and Automation, 2002 Proceedings ICRA '02. IEEE International Conference on Robotics and Automation, 2092, vol. 2, pp. 2092-2097, 6 pages. |
Human-Interactive Medical Robotics, Rony A. Abovitz, M.S., Computer Assisted Orthopedic Surgery (“CAOS”), 2000, pp. 71-72, 2 pages. |
Image-Guided Manipulator Compliant Surgical Planning Methodology for Robotic Skull-Base Surgery, Wan Sing Ng; Ming Yeong Teo; Yong-Chong Loh; Tseng Tsai Yeo, Medical Imaging and Augmented Reality, 2001 IEEE, pp. 26-29, 4 pages. |
Intra-operative Application of a Robotic Knee Surgery System, S. J. Harris, M. Jakopec, J. Cobb, B. L. Davies, Medical Image Computing and Computer-Assisted Intervention—MICCAI'99, Lecture Notes in Computer Science vol. 1679, 1999, pp. 1116-1124; 9 pages. |
Intraoperative Navigation Techniques Accuracy Tests and Clinical Report, S. Hassfeld, C. Burghart, I. Bertovic, J. Raczkowsky, U. Rembod, H. Worn and J. Muling, 1998, pp. 670-675, 6 pages. |
Issues in the Haptic Display of Tool Use, J. Edward Colgate, Michael C. Stanley and J. Michael Brown, IROS, 1995, 6 pages. |
Machining and Accuracy Studies for a Tibial Knee Implant Using a Force-Controlled Robot, Computer Aided Surgery, 1998, pp. 123-133, 11 pages. |
Orto Maquet and Caspar: An Automated Cell for Prosthesis Surgery, Sep./Oct. 1999 Robotics World, pp. 30-31, 2 pages. |
Premiers Pas Vers La Dissectomie et la Realisation de Protheses du Genou a L'Aide de Robots, M. Fadda, S. Martelli, P. Dario, M. Marcacci, S. Zaffagnini, A. Visani, Innov. Tech. Biol. Med., vol. 13, No. 4, 1992, pp. 394-409, 16 pages. |
Primary and Revision Total Hip Replacement Using the Robodoc System, William L. Bargar, Md, Andre Bauer, MD and Martin Börner, MD, Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, 1998, No. 354, pp. 82-91, 10 pages. |
Registration and immobilization in robot-assisted surgery, Jon T. Lea, Dane Watkins, Aaron Mills, Michael A. Peshkin, Thomas C. Kienzle III and S. David Stulberg, Journal of Image Guided Surgery, 1995, vol. 1, No. 2, pp. 80-87, 11 pages. |
Registration Graphs A Language for Modeling and Analyzing Registration in Image-Guided Surgery, Jon Thomas Lea, Dec. 1998, 1-49, 49 pages. |
Robot assisted craniofacial surgery: first clinical evaluation, C. Burghart, R. Krempien, T. Redlich, A. Pernozzoli, H. Grabowski, J. Muenchenberg, J. Albers, S. Haβfeld, C. Vahl, U. Rembold and H. Woern, 1999, 7 pages. |
Robot Assisted Knee Surgery, 4527 IEEE, Engineering in Medicine & Biology 14, May/Jun. 1995, No. 3, pp. 292-300, 9 pages. |
Robot Controlled Osteotomy in Craniofacial Surgery, Catherina Burghart, Jochen Keitel, Stefan Hassfeld, Ulrich Rembold and Heinz Woern, Haptic Devices in Medical Applications, Jun. 23, 1999; pp. 12-22, 13 pages. |
Robotergestützte Osteotomie in der craniofacialen Chirurgie, Catherina R. Burghart, GCA-Verlag, 2000, and partial English translation, 250 pages. |
Robotic Assistance in Orthopaedic Surgery A Proof of Principle Using Distal Femoral Arthroplasty, Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, 1993, No. 296, pp. 178-186, 9 pages. |
Robotic Execution of a Surgical Plan, Howard A. Paul, DVM, William L. Bargar, MD, Brent Mittlestadt, Peter Kazanzides, Ph.D., Bela Musites, Joel Suhars, Phillip W. Cain, Bill Williamson, Fred G. Smith, 1992 IEEE, 99. 1621-1623, 3 pages. |
Robotics in Minimally Invasive Surgery, Brian Davies, Mechatronics in Medicine Lab, IEE, 1996 The Institution of Electrical Engineers, pp. 1-2, 2 pages. |
Robotics in surgery a new generation of surgical tools incorporate computer technology and mechanical actuation to give surgeons much finer control than previously possible during some operations, Rob Buckingham, IEE Review, Sep. 1994, pp. 193-196, 4 pages. |
Safe Active Robotic Devices for Surgery, Ro Buckingham, Oct. 1993, vol. 5, pp. 355-358, 4 pages. |
Section 4 Robotic Systems and Task-Level Programming, A Model-Based Optimal Planning and Execution System with Active Sensing and Passive Manipulation for Augmentation of Human Precision in Computer-Integrated Surgery, Russell H. Taylor, Yong-Yil Kim, Alan D. Kalvin, David Larose, Betsy Haddad, Deljou Khoramabadi, Marilyn Noz, Robert Olyha, Nils Brunn and Dieter Grimm, Experimental Robotics II Lecture Notes in Control and Information Sciences, vol. 190, 1993, pp. 177-195, 19 pages. |
Semi-Active Guiding Systems in Surgery. A Two-DOF Prototype of the Passive Arm with Dynamic Constraints (PADyC), Jocelyne Troccaz, Yves Delnondedieu, Mechatronics vol. 6, No. 4, pp. 399-421, 1996, 23 pages. |
Surgical Robotics An Introduction, Ulrich Rembold and Catherina R. Burghart, Journal of Intelligent and Robotic Systems, vol. 30, Institute of Process Control and Robotics, 2001, pp. 1-28, 28 pages. |
Technique and first clinical results of robot-assisted total knee replacement, Werner Siebert, Sabine Mai, Rudolf Kober and Peter F. Heeckt, The Knee, vol. 9, 2002, pp. 173-130, 8 pages. |
The Robodoc Clinical Trial A Robotic Assistant for Total Hip Arthroplasty, Evelyn Harkins Spencer, Orthopaedic Nursing, Jan./Feb. 1996, vol. 15, No. 1, pp. 9-14, 6 pages. |
Three-Dimensional Digitizer (Neuronavigator); New Equipment for Computed Tomography-Guided Stereotaxic Surgery, Watanabe E, Watanabe T, Manaka S, Mayanagi Y, Takakura K., Surg Neurol., Jun. 1987, Issue 6, pp. 543-547, 5 pages. |
Visual and haptic collaborative tele-presence, Adnan Ansar, Denison Rodrigues, Jaydev P. Desai, Kostas Daniilidis, Vijay Kumar and Mario F.M. Campos, 2001, Computers & Graphics, pp. 789-798, 10 pages. |
U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, filed Jul. 2004, Bonutti. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Final Office Action dated Aug. 17, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Non-Final Rejection mailed Mar. 25, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Response to Office Action filed Apr. 30, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Response to Office Action filed Oct. 9, 2007. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review of U.S. Patent No. 7,749,229 Under 35 U.S.C. § 312 and 37 C.F.R. § 42.104; filed Sep. 25, 2013; IPR2013-00605; with exhibits, 519 pages. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review of U.S. Patent No. 6,702,821 Under 35 U.S.C. § 312 and 37 C.F.R. § 42.104; filed Sep. 25, 2013; IPR2013-00620; with exhibits, 571 pages. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review of U.S. Patent No. 8,133,229 Under 35 U.S.C. § 312 and 37 C.F.R. § 42.104; filed Sep. 25, 2013; IPR2013-00621; with exhibits, 437 pages. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review of U.S. Patent No. 7,806,896 Under 35 U.S.C. § 312 and 37 C.F.R. § 42.104; filed Sep. 26, 2013; IPR2013-00629; with exhibits, 650 pages. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review of U.S. Patent No. 7,837,736 Under 35 U.S.C. § 312 and 37 C.F.R. § 42.104; filed Nov. 22, 2013; IPR2014-00191; with exhibits, 425 pages. |
Corrected Petition for Inter Partes Review of U.S. Patent No. 7,837,736 Under 35 U.S.C. § 312 and 37 C.F.R. §42.104; filed Dec. 13, 2013; IPR2014-00191; 66 pages. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review of U.S. Patent No. 7,959,635 Under 35 U.S.C. § 312 and 37 C.F.R. § 42.104; filed Dec. 31, 2013; IPR2014-00311; 710 pages. |
Corrected Petition for Inter Partes Review of U.S. Patent No. 7,959,635 Under 35 U.S.C. § 312 and 37 C.F.R. § 42.104; filed Jan. 21, 2014; IPR2014-00311; 68 pages. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review of U.S. Patent No. 7,806,896 Under 35 U.S.C. § 312 and 37 C.F.R. § 42.104; filed Jan. 3, 2014; IPR2014-00321; with exhibitsm 462 pages. |
Corrected Petition for Inter Partes Review of U.S. Patent No. 7,806,896 Under 35 U.S.C. §§ 311-319 and 37 C.F.R. § 42.100 et seq.; filed Jan. 24, 2014; IPR2013-00321; with exhibits, 51 pages. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review of U.S. Patent No. 7,806,896 Under 35 U.S.C. § 312 and 37 C.F.R. § 42.104; filed Jan. 15, 2014; IPR2014-00354; with exhibits, 832 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Declaration of Chad J. Peterman in Support of Depuy's Opening Claim Construction Brief; Dec. 9, 2013; 15 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Declaration of Ian G. Dibernardo in Support of Plaintiff Bonutti Skeletal Innovation LLC's Preliminary Claim Construction Brief; Dec. 9, 2013; 31 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Declaration of Scott D. Schoifet, M.D. in Support of Plaintiff Bonutti Skeletal's Preliminary Claim Construction Brief; Dec. 9, 2013; 37 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Defendants' List of Proposed Claim Terms and Phrases for Interpretation; Oct. 3, 2013; 6 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Defendants' Preliminary Non-Infringement Disclosures; Aug. 29, 2013; 86 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Defendants' Proposed Claim Constructions; Oct. 10, 2013; 7 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Depuy's Opening Claim Construction Brief; Dec. 9, 2013; 35 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Joint Appendices A through I; Dec. 9, 2013; 413 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Plaintiff Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC's List of Proposed Claim Terms and Phrases for Interpretation; Oct. 3, 2013; 4 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Plaintiff Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC's Preliminary Claim Construction Brief; Dec. 9, 2013; 27 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Plaintiff Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC's Response to Defendants' Proposed Claim Constructions; Oct. 30, 2013; 14 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC 6 v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Plaintiff's Initial Preliminary Infringement Disclosures; May 30, 2013; 8 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; DePuy's Reply Claim Construction Brief; Jan. 16, 2014; 23 pages. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Plaintiff Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC's Claim Construction Reply Brief; Jan. 16, 2014; 24 pages. |
Andronico, John T., et al.; “The Series 7000 Total Knee System Surgical Protocol;” Pasport Anterior Referencing Instrumentation Osteonics; pp. 1-45; publication date unknown. |
Ashby, M., et al.; “Metal Foams a Design Guide;” Butterworth/Heinemanna published by Elservier © 2000—pp. 256. |
Askoxford.com—English Disctionary—definition of the word suspended; retrieved Jun. 18, 2009, 3 pages. |
Bell, Robert H., et al.; “Solar Total Shoulder System;” Surgical Protocol Stryker Osteonics, pp. 1-24. |
Berger et al., “Determining the Rotational Alignment of the Femoral Component in Total Knee Arthroplasty Using the Epicondylar Axis,” Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, No. 266, Jan. 1993, cover page and pp. 40-47. |
Declaration of Arthur G. Erdman, Ph.D Regarding U.S. Patent No. 7,837,736; IPR2014-00191; dated Nov. 21, 2013; 136 pages. |
Declaration of Arthur G. Erdman, Ph.D., Regarding U.S. Patent No. 7,806,896; IPR2014-00191; dated Jan. 2, 2014; 142 pages. |
Declaration of Jay D. Mabrey, MD, MBA Regarding U.S. Patent No. 7,749,229; IPR2013-00605; dated Sep. 24, 2013; 77 pages. |
Declaration of Jay D. Mabrey, MD, MBA Regarding U.S. Patent No. 6,702,821; IPR2013-00620; dated Sep. 25, 2013; 93 pages. |
Declaration of Jay D. Mabrey, MD, MBA Regarding U.S. Patent No. 8,133,229; IPR2013-00621; dated Sep. 25, 2013; 74 pages. |
Declaration of Jay D. Mabrey, MD, MBA Regarding U.S. Patent No. 7,806,896; IPR2013-00629; dated Sep. 25, 2013; 97 pages. |
Declaration of Lindsey Rolston, M.D., FAAOS, Regarding U.S. Patent No. 7,959,635; IPR 2014-00311; dated Dec. 30, 2013; 84 pages. |
DePuy; “The AMK Total Knee System;” Instrumentation Legend II; 1996, DP00001514-DP00001545, 32 pages. |
Depuy, “The AMK Total Knee System,” Total Knee Replacement Using the AMK Legend II Instrument System, Copyright 1994, 30 pages. |
DePuy, LCS Uni—Unicompartmental Knee System with Porocoat Porous Coating (written in conjunction with Jean-Louis Briard, Peter A. Keblish and Frederick Buechel), ((1998) and LCS Uni Table Size 5 (on sale pre-2000)). |
Dow Corning Wright; “Lacey Condylar Total Knee System;” Surgical Procedure; 12 pages. |
Elzey, D.M., et al.; “The Limits of Solid State Forming;” Department of Materials Science and Engineering, published by Elservier, © 2001 Acta mater 49, 849-859, pp. 11. |
Fisher, David; “Implant Position in Knee Surgery: A Comparison of Min Open Unicompartmental, and Total Knee Arthroplasty;” 2003. |
Griffin et al.; “Anatomy of the Epicondyles of the Distal Femur;” The Journal of Arthroplasty vol. 15, No. 3, 2000, pp. 354-359. |
Hofmann, Aaron A., et al.; “Subvastus (Southern) Approach for Primary Total Knee Arthroplasty;” Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research; No. 269; Aug. 1991; pp. 70-77. |
Hofmann, Aaron A., et al.; “Sulzer Orthopedics Natural-Knee II System Surgical Technique;” SulzerMedica; pp. 1-47; Copyright 1998. |
Hungerford et al., “P.C.A. Modular Total Knee System Surgical Technique,” Pfizer/Howmedica, Copyright 1989, 94 pages. |
Hitt et al., “Anthropometric Measurements of the Human Knee: Correlation to the Sizing of Current Knee Arthroplasty Systems,” Journal of Bone and Joint Surgery, 2003, 85, pp. 115-122. |
Kazanzides et al., “An Integrated System for Cementless Hip Replacement, Robotics and Medical Imaging Technology Enhance Precision Surgery,” IEEE Engineering in Medicine and Biology, May/Jun. 1995, pp. 307-313. |
Keblish, Peter A., “Surgical Techniques in the Performance of Unicompartmental Arthroplasties,” Operative Techniques in Orthopaedics, vol. 8, No. 3 Jul. 1998, 12 pgs. |
Keys; “Reduced Invasive Approach for Oxford II Medical Unicompartmental Knee Replacement—a Preliminary Study;” 6 The Knee 193; Mar. 1999. |
Khodabandehloo et al., “Chapter 17: Special-Purpose Actuators and Architectures for Surgery Robots,” in Computer-Integrated Surgery Technology and Clinical Applications, edited by Taylor et al., The MIT Press, Copyright 1996, pp. 263-275 and 3 cover pages. |
Marchetti, Pier Giorgio, et al.; “Restoration T3 Femoral Component Using the Command Instrument System;” Revision Surgical Technique Stryker Howmedica Osteonics; publication date unknown; pp. 1-24. |
Matsueda, Gustilo, Subvastus and Medial Parapatellar Approaches in Total Knee Arthroplasty, 371 Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research 161; 2000. |
Mensch et al., “Knee Morphology as a Guide to Knee Replacement,” Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, No. 112, Oct. 1975, cover pages and pp. 231-241. |
msn.com—Encarta Dictionary—definition of the word suspended. |
NexGen Complete Knee Solution—Epicondylar Instrumentation Surgical Technique for Legacy Posterior Stabilized Knee, Copyright 1996, 31 pages. |
NexGen Complete Knee Solution—Multi-Reference TM 4-in-1 Femoral Instrumentation—Anterior Reference Surgical Technique—Publication date unknown, but before Aug. 1, 2001. |
NexGen Posterior Stabilized, The Complete Knee Solution, Copyright 1994, 8 pages. |
Poilvache et al., “Rotational Landmarks and Sizing of the Distal Femur in Total Knee Arthroplasty,” Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, No. 331, pp. 35-46, Oct. 1996. |
Portheine, Radermacher; “Development of a Clinical Demonstrator for Computer Assisted Orthopedic Surgery with CT-image Based Individual Templates (chapter in Computer Assisted Radiology and Surgery, edited by H.U. Lemke, M.W. Vannier and K. Inamura);” 1997. |
Radermacher; “Image Guided Orthopedic Surgery Using Individual Templates,” Lecture Notes in Computer Science, 1997, p. 606-615. |
Radermacher; “Technique for Better Execution of CT Scan Planned Orthopedic Surgery on Bone Structures,” Car-Symposium, 1995, pp. 934-938. |
Ranawat, Chitranjan S., et al.; “Technique of Total Knee Arthroplasty with Precision Cut Instruments;” Total-Condylar Knee Arthorplasty—Technique, Results, and Complications; 1985; 2 cover pages and pp. 69-83. |
Richards; “Intracondylar Knee;” 1979; 20 pages. |
Romanowski, Repicci; “Minimally Invasive Unicondylar Arthroplasty;” J. Knee Surgery, 2002, 15: 17-22. |
Scorpio Single Axis Total Knee System—Passport Total Knee Instrumentation—Passport A.R. Surgical Technique—Publication date unknown, but before Aug. 1, 2001. |
Smith & Nephew; “Genesis Unicompartmental Knee System;” Surgical Technique; Feb. 1994; 38 pages. |
Smith & Nephew; “Profix Total Knee System;” Surgical Technique; 1998; 73 pages. |
Takata et al., “A Cutting Simulation System for Machinability Evaluation Using a Workpiece Model,” Annals of the CIRP, vol. 38, 1989, pp. 417-420. |
Taylor et al., “An Image-Directed Robotic System for Precise Orthopaedic Surgery,” IEEE Transactions on Robotics and Automation, vol. 10, No. 3, Jun. 1994, pp. 261-275. |
Taylor et al., “Redundant Consistency Checking in a Precise Surgical Robot,” Annual International Conference of the IEEE Engineering in Medicine and Biology Society, vol. 12, No. 5, 1990, pp. 1933-1935. |
The American Heritage College Dictionary, Third Edition, Houghton Mifflin Company, defining customize, 1993, 3 pages. |
The New Oxford American Dictionary, Second Edition, Edited by Jewell et al., defining customize, 2005, 3 pages. |
The P.C.A. Primary Total Knee System—Alignment Rationale, Howmedica, Publication date unknown, but prior to Jan. 14, 2000, pp. 8-23. |
Kenna et al., “The P.C.A. Primary Total Knee System—Surgical Technique,” Publication date unknown, but prior to Jan. 14, 2000, 77 pages. |
Total Knee Replacement Computer assisted surgical system uses a calibrated robot, May/Jun. 1995, IEEE Engineering in Medicine and Biology; A Computer Assisted Total Knee Replacement Surgical System Using a Calibrated Robot, Thomas C. Kienzle 111, S. David Stulberg, Michael Peshkin, Arthur Quaid, Jon Lea, Ambarish Goswami, Chi hau Engineering in Medicine and Biology vol. 14, Issue 3, May 1995, pp. 301-306, 35 pages. |
Turner, Roderick H. et al.; “Geometric and Anametric Total Knee Replacement;” Total Knee Replacement, 1980; 2 cover pages and pp. 171-193. |
Webster's New College Dictionary, Edited by Michael Agnes, defining customize, 2007, 3 pages. |
Yoshioka et al., “The Anatomy and Functional Axes of the Femur,” The Journal of Bone and Joint Surgery, vol. 69-A, No. 6, Jul. 1987, pp. 873-880. |
Zimmer, “The MGII Cutting Guide Drawing,” Dimensioned Zimmer engineering drawing (redacted) identified by Item No. 00-5120-930-01, with several dates, all of which are earlier than 1995, 1 page. |
Zimmer, “The NexGen Cutting Guide Drawing,” Dimensioned Zimmer engineering drawing identified by item No. 00-5967-930-01, with several dates, all of which are earlier than 1999, 1 page. |
Zimmer, Casey Total Knee, Copyright 1976, 22 pages. |
Zimmer, “Hips, Knees, & Other Prosthetic Implants,” Zimmer Product catalog, Copyright Oct. 1997, 23 pages. |
Zimmer, Mobile Bearing Knee (MBK), Rotational Freedom Anatomic Function, Copyright 1997, 6 pages. |
Zimmer, Mobile Bearing Knee (MBK), Implant & Instrument Order Form, Sep. 1998, 7 pages. |
Zimmer, Micro-Mill Instrument Surgical Technique for Mobile Bearing Knees (MBK), Copyright 1997, 36 pages. |
Zimmer, Intramedullary Instrument Surgical Technique for Mobile Bearing Knee (MBK), Copyright 1997, 28 pages. |
Zimmer, “MG II Total Knee System Surgical Technique,” Copyright 1989, 42 pages. |
Zimmer, “MG II Total Knee System,” Copyright 1992, 26 pages. |
Zimmer; “Minimally Invasive Solution, The M/G Unicompartmental Knee Minimally Invasive Surgical Technique;” 2000; 33 pgs. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,902, Final Rejection mailed Jan. 26, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,902, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jun. 9, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,902, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jun. 14, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,902, Non-Final Rejection mailed Dec. 17, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,902, Response to Office Action filed May 26, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,902, Response to Office Action filed Oct. 10, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,902, Response to Office Action filed Apr. 17, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,902, Response to Office Action filed Sep. 9, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,902, Response to Office Action filed Oct. 13, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/037,535, Advisory Action mailed May 14, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/037,535, Examiner Interview Summary mailed May 1, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/037,535, Final Rejection mailed Jan. 30, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/037,535, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jul. 17, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/037,535, Response to Office Action filed Nov. 19, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/037,535, Response to Office Action filed Apr. 30, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,676, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jun. 14, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,676, Non-Final Rejection mailed Nov. 24, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,676, Non-Final Rejection mailed Apr. 14, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,676, Final Rejection mailed Jun. 1, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,676, Final Rejection mailed Jan. 30, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,676, Response to Office Action filed Mar. 31, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,676, Response to Office Action filed Aug. 14, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,676, Response to Office Action filed Mar. 20, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,676, Response to Office Action filed Sep. 1, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,676, Response to Office Action filed Sep. 8, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,676, Response to Office Action filed Nov. 14, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/928,898, Non-Final Rejection mailed Mar. 11, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/684,103, Non-Final Rejection mailed Nov. 23, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11,684,178, Non-Final Rejection mailed Feb. 24, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/88,783, Final Rejection mailed May 28, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Response to Office Action filed Jun. 3, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11,684,178, Final Rejection mailed Jun. 10, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Request for Continued Examination filed Jun. 15, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11,684,178, Response to Office Action filed Dec. 10, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783,Response to Office Action filed Sep. 28, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783,Advisory mailed Oct. 13, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783,Notice of Appeal Nov. 29, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, RCE filed Jun. 29, 2011. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, Office action mailed Oct. 13, 2011. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 12/784,724, filed May 21, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 12/795,935, filed Jun. 8, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 13/221,033, filed Aug. 30, 2011. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 13/407,448, filed Feb. 28, 2012. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 13/407,968, filed Feb. 29, 2012. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Response to Office Action filed Apr. 17, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Response to Office Action filed Jun. 25, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Response to Office Action filed Sep. 29, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Examiner Interview Summary mailed May 1, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Final Rejection mailed Feb. 4, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Final Rejection mailed Jun. 12, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jun. 14, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Final Rejection mailed Nov. 5, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Non-Final Rejection mailed May 15, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Non-Final Rejection mailed Nov. 21, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Response to Office Action filed May 5, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Response to Office Action filed May 9, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Response to Office Action filed May 15, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Response to Office Action filed Aug. 15, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Response to Office Action filed Nov. 14, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Response to Office Action filed Feb. 12, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Response to Office Action filed Mar. 20, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Response to Office Action filed Sep. 14, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/170,969, Supplemental Final Rejection mailed Nov. 12, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,700, Examiner Interview Summary mailed May 1, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,700, Final Rejection mailed Mar. 11, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,700, Final Rejection mailed Feb. 4, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,700, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jun. 14, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,700, Non-Final Rejection mailed May 28, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,700, Non-Final Rejection mailed Sep. 18, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,700, Response to Offfice Action filed Dec. 18, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,700, Response to Office Action filed Jul. 13, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,700, Response to Office Action filed Oct. 28, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,700, Response to Office Action filed Nov. 14, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,700, Response to Office Action filed May 5, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, Final Rejection mailed Jul. 11, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, Final Rejection mailed Feb. 21, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, Non-Final Rejection mailed Nov. 29, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jul. 20, 2006. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, Non-Final Rejection mailed Sep. 14, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, Response to Office Action filed Sep. 7, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, Response to Office Action filed Mar. 31, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, Response to Office Action filed May 21, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, Response to Office Action filed Dec. 20, 2006. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783,Response to Office Action filed May 30, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783,Response to Office Action filed Nov. 10, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,902, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jul. 11, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/171,902, Examiner Interview Summary mailed Apr. 8, 2008. |
M. Bottlang, Ph.D, et al., A Mobile-bearing Knee Prosthesis Can Reduce Strain at the Proximal Tibia, Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, No. 447, pp. 105-111, Copyright © 2006, Lippincott Williams & Wilkins, retrieved Jan. 13, 2010. |
Seo SS, et al., Effect of Posterior Condylar Offset on Cruciate-Retaining Mobile TKA, Pusan Paik Hospital, College of Medicine, www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov, PubMed, p. 1, Copyright © 2009, retrieved Jan. 13, 2010. |
ScienceDirect, —The Knee—Influence of Posterior Condylar Offset on Knee Flexion After Cruciate-Sacrificing Mobile-Bearing Total Knee Replacement: A prospective Analysis of 410 Consecutive Cases., Published by Elsevier B.V., www.sciencedirect.com, 3 pgs., Copyright @ 2009, retrieved Jan. 13, 2010. |
B.M. Hanratty et al., The Influence of Posterior Condylar Offset on Knee Flexion After Total Knee Replacement Using Cruciate-Sacrificing Mobile-Bearing Implant., Journal of Bone and Joint Surgery, British vol. 89-B, iSSUE 7, 915-918, Copyright 02007, British Editorial Society of Bone and Joint Surgery—retrieved Jan. 12, 2010. |
Accuris Redefining the Uni Knee, Minimally Invasive Unicompartmental Knee System, Smith & Nephew, May 2003. |
AVON™ Patello-Femoral Arthroplasty, Christopher E. Ackroyd, Stryker Howmedica Ostionics, © 2002. |
Clinical Orthopaedics, Long-Term Results with the First Patellofemoral Prosthesis,Phillipe Cartier, pp. 46-54, Jul. 2005. |
FxRx, Stryker Howmedica Osteonics, Indian Summer 2003. |
ImmediateCare™ External Fixation Systems Sterile Ankle Kit, Stryker Howmedica Osteonics, © 2002. |
ImmediateCare™ External Fixation Systems Sterile Wrist Fixator, Stryker Howmedica Osteonics, © 2002. |
Insall/Burstein II Modular Knee System—Publication date unknown, but before Aug. 1, 2001. |
NexGen Complete Knee Solution—Design Rationale—Publication date unknown, but before Aug. 1, 2001. |
NexGen Complete Knee Solution—Extramedullary/ Intramedullary Tibial Resector Surgical Technique—Publication date unknown, but before Aug. 1, 2001. |
NexGen Complete Knee Solution—Intramedully Instrumentation Technique—for the NexGen Cruciate Retaining & Legacy® Posterior Stabilized Knee—Publication date unknown, but before Aug. 1, 2001. |
NexGen Complete Knee Solution—Surgical Technique for the LPS-Flex Fixed Bearing Knee—Publication date unknown, but before Aug. 1, 2001. |
Operative Arthroscopy—John B. McGinty M.D.—Department of Orthopedic Surgery, Medical University of South Carolina, Charleston, South Carolina—© 1991 by Raven Press, Ltd., p. 9. |
Scorpio Single Axis Total Knee System—Passport Total Knee Instrumentation—Passport P[A?].R Surgical Technique—Publication date unknown, but before Aug. 1, 2001. |
Scorpio Single Axis Total Knee System—Stryker® Howmedica Osteonics—One Revolutionary Idea, Three great Potential Benefits, Mar. 2000. |
Scorpio Total Knee System—Stryker® Howmedica Osteonics, (1-50 pgs), Publication date unknown. |
Scorpio Total Stabilizer Revision Knee System Surgical Protocol, ScorpioTS Single Axis Total Knee System, Stryker® Howmedica Osteonics, Jan. 2001. |
Simplex Enhancement Systems, Howmedica Catalog, pp. 3-4, 1990. |
“Sterile Yellow Monotube® TRIAX™ Kit, Stryker Howmedica Osteonics, © 2001.”. |
Sulzer Orthopedics TM Natural-Knee 0 II System Surgical Technique—© 1998 Sulzer Orthopedics Inc. |
Surgical Navigation for Total Knee Arthroplasty—Believed to have been presented at the American Academy of Orthopedic Surgeons in Feb. of 2001. |
Surgical Protocol—Solar TM Total Shoulder System—© Osteonics Corp. 1998. |
Surgical Technique—Stryker ® Howmedica Osteonics—Restoration TM T3 Femoral Component Using the Command® Instrument System, Feb. 2000. |
The M/G Unicompartmental Knee—Minimally Invasive Surgical Technique—Publication date unknown, but before Aug. 1, 2001. |
The Series 7000 Total Knee System—Passport A.R. Total Knee Instruments—© Osteonics 1996. |
Total Joints Orthopedic, Richards Modular Knee, Richards Manufacturing Company, Publication date unknown, but before 2001. |
Zimmer Catalog, Wilder Retractors, pp. 38-39, © 1972. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/037,855, Non-Final Rejection mailed Nov. 17, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/037,855, Response to Office Action filed Aug. 24, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/037,855, Non-Final Rejection mailed May 22, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 11/037,855, Final Rejection mailed May 14, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Non-Final Rejection mailed Feb. 23, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Final Rejection mailed Aug. 7, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Final Rejection mailed Aug. 18, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jan. 9, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Non-Final Rejection mailed Aug. 18, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Non-Final Rejection mailed Dec. 24, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Request for Continued Examination (RCE) filed Oct. 20, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Response to Office Action filed Dec. 18, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Response to Office Action Apr. 9, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Response to Office Action Oct. 20, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Response to Office Action Oct. 29, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Response to Office Action filed May 19, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Response to Office Action filed May 23, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Response to Office Action filed Oct. 20, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Response to Office Action filed Oct. 29, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/795,887, Request for Continued Examination (RCE) filed Oct. 20, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Final Rejection mailed Oct. 18, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Requirement for Restriction/Election mailed Aug. 30, 2006. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Advisory Action mailed Jan. 7, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Advisory Actionmailed Jun. 30, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Final Rejection mailed Mar. 18, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Non-Final Rejection mailed Dec. 3, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jun. 23, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Non-Final Rejection mailed Dec. 27, 2006. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Notice Non-Compliant mailed Oct. 23, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Request for Continued Examination (RCE) filed Mar. 18, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Response to Office Action filed Jun. 18, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Response to Office Action filed Apr. 27, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Response to Office Action filed Sep. 23, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Response to Office Action filed Oct. 2, 2006. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Response to Office Action filed Oct. 29, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Response to Office Action filed Sep. 18, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/684,904, Response to Office Action filed Dec. 18, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Final Rejection mailed Sep. 22, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Advisory Action mailed Jan. 4, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Examiner Interview Summary mailed Apr. 13, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Final Rejection mailed Dec. 17, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Final Rejection mailed Dec. 31, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jul. 9, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jan. 30, 2007. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Non-Final Rejection mailed Jun. 27, 2008. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Response to Offfice Action filed Jan. 4, 2010. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Response to Offfice Action filed Dec. 22, 2009. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 10/722,102, Response to Office Action filed Mar. 2, 2009. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review, filed Nov. 22, 2013, related to USP 7837736, IPR 2014-00191. |
Declaration of Arthur G. Erdman, Ph.D., dated Nov. 21, 2013, Exhibit 1005 in IPR 2014-00191. |
Zimmer “Mbk Intramedullary Instrument Surgical Technique for Mobile Bearing Knee” surgical guide (“Mbk intramedullary surgical guide”), Exhibit 1010 in IPR 2014-00191. |
Zimmer, “Mbk Mobile Bearing Knee” brochure, Exhibit 1007 in IPR 2014-00191. |
Zimmer “Mbk Mobile Bearing Knee Implant & Instrument Order Form” (“Mbk order form”), Exhibit 1008 in IPR 2014-00191. |
Zimmer “Micro-Mill Instrument Surgical Technique for Mobile Bearing Knees” surgical guide (“Mbk Micro-Mill surgical guide”), Exhibit 1009 in IPR 2014-00191. |
M. Ashby et al., Metal Foams a Design Guide, Butterworth/Heinemanna published by Elservier © 2000—pp. 267. |
D.M. Elzey et al., The Limits of Solid State Forming, Department of Materials Science and Engineering, published by Elservier, © 2001 Acta mater 49, 849-589, pp. 11. |
U.S. Appl. No. 10/888,783, filed Jul. 9, 2004 for Peter M. Bonutti. |
Bonutti Skeletal Innovations LLC v. DePuy Mitek LLC, et al.; Civil Action No. 1:12-cv-11667; United States District Court District of Massachusetts; Defendants' Preliminary Invalidity Disclosures; Aug. 29, 2013; 73 pages. |
Bert, Jack M.; “Universal Intramedullary Instrumentation for Unicompartmental Total Knee Arthroplasty;” Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research, No. 271; Oct. 1991; cover pages and pp. 79-87. |
Bonutti, Peter M., et al.; “Scientific Evidence for the Use of Modern Unicompartmental Knee Arthroplasty;” Expert Review of Medical Devices; Mar. 2010; 30 pages. |
Bonutti; “Unicompartmental Knee Arthroplasty: a US Experience;” 1997. |
Buechel, et al.; “Low Contact Stress Meniscal Bearing Unicompartmental Knee Replacement: Long-Term Evaluation of Cemented and Cementless Results;” 7 J. Orthopaedic Rheumatology 31, 1994 (presented at a Feb. 1990 meeting). |
Buechel; “Meniscal-Bearing Total Knee Arthropolasty (chapter 10 in Surgical Techniques in Total Knee Arthroplasty, edited by Giles Scuderi and Alfred Tria);” 2002. |
Buechel; “NJ Tricompartmental Total Knee System; ” with porocoat; 1984. |
Buechel; “Surgical Meniscal-Bearing Total Knee Arthroplasty;” 2002. |
DePuy; “ The AMK Total Knee System;” Instrumentation Legend II; 1992. |
DePuy, LCS Uni—Unicompartmental Knee System with Porocoat Porous Coating (written in conjunction with Jean-Louis Briard, Peter A. Keblish and Frederick Buechel)(, (1998) and LCS Uni Table Size 5 (on sale pre-2000). |
DePuy, Buechel; “Preliminary New Jersey LCS Total Knee System;” 1998. |
Epinette, J.-A., et al.; “Hydroxyapatite-Coated Unicompartmental Knee Replacement a Report of Five to Six Years' Follow-up of the HA Unix Tibial Component;” Unicompartmental Knee Arthroplasty; 1997; cover and pp. 243-305. |
Fiddian, Blakeway, Kumar; “Replacement Arthroplasty of the Valgus Knee: A Modified Lateral Capsular Approach with Repositioning of Vastus Lateralis;” 80-B J. Bone & Joint Surgery 859; Sep. 1998. |
Fischer, David; “Implant Position in Knee Surgery: A Comparison of Min Open Unicompartmental, and Total Knee Arthroplasty;” 2003. |
Goble; “Minimally Invasive Total Knee Replacement;” 2004. |
Griffin et al.; “Anatomy of the Epicondyles of the Distal Femur;” 2000. |
JBJS, “Anthropometric Measurements of the Human Knee,” 2003. |
Johnson, DF; Love, DT; Love, BR; Lester, DK; Dermal Hypoesthesia after Total Knee Arthroplasty; AM J Orthop; Nov. 2000; 29(11):863-6. |
“Ketone-based Resins,” author unknown, Modern Plastics, pp. 21-11, Mid-Oct. 1991. |
Keys; “Reduced Invasive Approach for Oxford II Medical Unicomppartmental Knee Replacement—A Preliminary Study;” 6 The Knee 193; Mar. 1999. |
Total Knee Replacement Computer-assisted surgical system uses a calibrated robot, May/Jun. 1995, IEEE Engineering in Medicine and Biology; A Computer-Assisted Total Knee Replacement Surgical System Using a Calibrated Robot, Thomas C. Kienzle III, S. David Stulberg, Michael Peshkin, Arthur Quaid, Jon Lea, Ambarish Goswami, Chi-hau Engineering in Medicine and Biology vol. 14, Issue 3, May 1995, pp. 301-306, 35 pages. |
Matsueda, Gustilo, Subvastus and Medial Parapatellar Approaches in Total KneeArthroplasty, 371 Clinical Orthopaedics and Related Research 161; 2000. |
“modular”. Merriam-Webster Online Dictionary [online], [retrieved on Jan. 7, 2006]. Retrieved from the Internet <URL:www.m-w.com. |
“module”. Merriam-Webster Online Dictionary [online], [retrieved on Jan. 7, 2006]. Retrieved from the Internet <URL:www.m-w.com. |
O'Donnel; “The Repicci II Unicondylar Knee Arthroplasty;” 2010. |
Parratte, et al., Survival of Biocompartmental Knee Arthroplasty at 5 to 23 years, Clin Orthop Relat Res, The Association of Bone and Joint Surgeons, Aug. 8, 2009. |
Portheine, Radermacher; “Development of a Clinical Demonstrator for Computer Assisted Orthopedic Surgery with CT-image Based Individual Templates;” 1997. |
Radermacher; “Clinical Experience With the Individual Template Technique;” 2001. |
Radermacher; “Computer Assisted Matching of Planning and Execution in Orthopedic Surgery;” 1993. |
Radermacher; “Computer Assisted Orthopedic Surgery by Means of Individual Templates Aspects and Analysis of Potential Applications;” 1994. |
Radermacher, Birnbaum; “Computer-Assisted Orthopedic Surgery with Individual Templates and Comparison to Conventional Operation Method;” 2001. |
Radermacher; “Computer-Assisted Planning and Execution of Orthopedic Surgery Using Individual Surgical Templates;” 1999. |
Radermacher, Froemel; “Computer Assisted Template Based Navigation for Total Knee Replacement;” 2001. |
Radermacher; “Computer Assisted Total Knee-Endoprothesis Using Planning Specific Individual Templates;” 1999-2000. |
Radermacher; “Computer-Integrated Orthopaedic Surgery: Connection of Planning and Execution in Surgical Intervention (chapter 33 in Computer-Integrated Surgery: Technology and Clinical Applications, edited by Russell Taylor, Stephane Lavallee, Grigore Burdea, Ralph Mosges);” 1995. |
Radermacher; “CT Image-Based Planning and Execution of Interventions in Orthopedic Surgery Using Individual Templates (chapter in Computer Assisted Orthopedic Surgery, edited by L.P. Nolte and R. Ganz);” 1999. |
Radermacher; “Development of a Clinical Demonstrater for Computer Assisted Orthopedic Surgery with CT-Image Based Individual Templates (chapter in Computer Assisted Radiology and Surgery, edited by H.U. Lemke, M.W. Vannier and K. Inamura);” 1997. |
Radermacher; “Potentials of CT-Based Planning and Template-Based Procedure in Hip and Knee Surgery;” 2000. |
Romanowski, Repicci; “Minimally Invasive Unicondylar Arthroplasty;” 2002. |
Rosenberg; “Surgical Technique of Posterior Cruciate: Sacrificing and Preserving Total Knee Arthroplasty (chapter in Total Knee Arthroplasty edited by James A. Rand);” 1993. |
Stryker Howmedica Osteonics; “Scorpio Single Axis Total Knee System;” Passport A.R. Surgical Technique; 2000; 54 pages. |
Wu, Chi-haur, et al.; “An Integrated CT-Imaging, CAD-Based System for Orthopedic Surgery;” Robotics and Automation; May 1993; pp. 895-900. |
www.wordsmyth.net—Internet Dictionary—definition for “schematic”—Retreived Jun. 2, 2010. |
Zimmer; “Miller/Galante Total Knee System (Unicompartmental Surgical Technique);” 2000. |
Taylor, Redundant Consistency Checking in a Precise Surgical Robot, Annual Intl Conf of the IEEE Eng in Med and Bio Socy, vol. 12, No. 5, 1980, p. 1933-1935. |
Kazanzides, An Integrated System for Cementless Hip Replacement, May/Jun. 1995, IEEE Engineering in Medicine and Biology, p. 307-313. |
Taylor, An Image-Directed Robotic System for Precise Orthopaedic Surgery, IEEE Transactons on Robotics and Automation, vol. 10, No. 3, Jun. 1994, p. 261-274. |
Khodabandahloo, Computer Integrated Surgery: Chapter 17—Special-Purpose Actuators and Architectures for Surgery Robotics, 1996. |
Takata, A Cutting Simulation System for Machinability Evaluation Using a Workplace Model, Annals of the CIRP vol. 38//1/1989; received Jan. 1989. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 14/451,562, Non-Final Rejection mailed Sep. 8, 2014. |
Copending U.S. Appl. No. 14/451,562, Response filed Dec. 8, 2014. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review 2013-00605, related to USP 7749229, filed Sep. 25, 2013. |
Declaration of Jay Mabrey, regarding USP 7749229, dated Sep. 24, 2013. |
Lacey Condylar Total Knee System Surgical Procedure Data sheet. |
Webster's New College Dictionary, containing the definition of “customize”, 2007. |
American Heritage College Dictionary, third edition, containing the definition of “customize”, 1993. |
Smith & Nephew, Profix TKA Technique Guide, Jan. 1998. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review 2013-00620, related to U.S. Patent No. 6,702,821, filed Sep. 25, 2013. |
Declaration of Jay Mabrey regarding U.S. Patent No. 6,702,821 dated Sep. 25, 2013. |
Turner et al, Chapter 12: Geometric and Anametric Total Knee Replacement,Total Knee Replacement, 1980. |
Ranawat and Dorr, Chapter 5G: Technique of Total Knee Arthroplasty with Precision Cut Instruments, Total-Condylar Knee Arthroplasty: Technique, Results and Complications, 1985. |
New Oxford American Dictionary, p. 3, containing the definition of “customize” 2005. |
Declaration of Jay D. Mabrey, MD, MBA Regarding U.S. Patent No. 7,806,896 dated Sep. 25, 2013. |
Richards Intracondylar Knee brochure, 1979. |
Genesis Unicompartmental Knee System: Modular Unicompartmental Knee System Brochure, Smith & Nephew, 1994. |
Keblish, Surgical Techniques in the Performance of Unicompartmental Arthroplasties, Operative Techniques in Orthopaedics, vol. 8, No. 3 Jul. 1998: pp. 134-145. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review 2013-00621, related to U.S. Patent No. 8,133,229, filed Sep. 25, 2013. |
Declaration of Jay Mabrey, regarding U.S. Patent No. 8,133,229, dated Sep. 25, 2013. |
Zimmer Unicompartmental knee Minimally Invasive Surgical Technique Guide 2000 Zimmer Technique Guide. |
Petition for Inter Partes Review 2013-00629, related to US Patent No. 7,806,896, filed Sep. 26, 2013. |
Scorpio Single Axis total Knee system: Passport A.R.—Surgical Technique, Stryker Howmedica, 2000. |
Number | Date | Country | |
---|---|---|---|
20120221017 A1 | Aug 2012 | US |
Number | Date | Country | |
---|---|---|---|
Parent | 13407448 | Feb 2012 | US |
Child | 13407968 | US | |
Parent | 13221033 | Aug 2011 | US |
Child | 13407448 | US | |
Parent | 12795935 | Jun 2010 | US |
Child | 13221033 | US | |
Parent | 11684103 | Mar 2007 | US |
Child | 12795935 | US | |
Parent | 10681526 | Oct 2003 | US |
Child | 11684103 | US | |
Parent | 10191751 | Jul 2002 | US |
Child | 10681526 | US |
Number | Date | Country | |
---|---|---|---|
Parent | 09976396 | Oct 2001 | US |
Child | 10191751 | US | |
Parent | 09941185 | Aug 2001 | US |
Child | 09976396 | US | |
Parent | 09556070 | May 2000 | US |
Child | 09941185 | US | |
Parent | 09737380 | Dec 2000 | US |
Child | 09556070 | US | |
Parent | 09569020 | May 2000 | US |
Child | 09737380 | US | |
Parent | 09483676 | Jan 2000 | US |
Child | 09569020 | US | |
Parent | 09798870 | Mar 2001 | US |
Child | 09483676 | US | |
Parent | 09526949 | Mar 2000 | US |
Child | 09798870 | US | |
Parent | 09789621 | Feb 2001 | US |
Child | 09526949 | US |